GUI Guide
GUI Guide
March 2009
Siemens Energy, Inc. Siemens Power Technologies International 400 State Street, PO Box 1058 Schenectady, NY 12301-1058 USA +1 518-395-5000 www.siemens.com/power-technologies
Copyright 1990-2009 Siemens Energy, Inc., Siemens Power Technologies International (Siemens PTI) Information in this manual and any software described herein is confidential and subject to change without notice and does not represent a commitment on the part of Siemens PTI. The software described in this manual is furnished under a license agreement or nondisclosure agreement and may be used or copied only in accordance with the terms of the agreement. No part of this manual may be reproduced or transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic or mechanical, including photocopying, for any purpose other than the purchasers personal use, without the express written permission of Siemens PTI. PSSE high-performance transmission planning software is a registered trademark of Siemens PTI in the United States and other countries. The Windows 2000 operating system, the Windows XP operating system, the Windows Vista operating system, the Visual C++ development system, Microsoft Office Excel and Microsoft Visual Studio are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the United States and other countries. Intel Visual Fortran Compiler for Windows is a trademark of Intel Corporation in the United States and other countries. The Python programming language is a trademark of the Python Software Foundation. Other names may be trademarks of their respective owners.
Table of Contents
Contents
1.10 Creating a Working Case . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-17 1.11 Data Input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-18 1.11.1 Resetting Dialog Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-19 1.11.2 Closing the Application . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-19
2.3
Network Spreadsheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9 2.3.1 2.3.2 2.3.3 Revising the Working Case . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10 Creating a Bus Subsystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10 Using the Subsystem Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-11 Revising OPF Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-14 Models Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-16 Data Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-19
2.4 2.5
Models Spreadsheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-20 Event Spreadsheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-21 Exporting Spreadsheet Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-22 Undoing an Action . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-22
Diagram Templates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-13 Revising a Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-14 3.6.1 3.6.2 3.6.3 3.6.4 3.6.5 3.6.6 3.6.7 3.6.8 3.6.9 Using Data Records . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-14 Using Diagram Menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-15 Editing Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16 Binding Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-17 Displaying and Modifying Network Elements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-18 Drawing a Missing Bus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-25 Renumbering Buses in the Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-25 Specifying Bus Locations from a File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-25 Moving Diagram Elements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-29
3.6.10 Changing Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-31 3.6.11 Displaying ISO Symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-32 3.6.12 Animating Flows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-32 3.6.13 Viewing Current Loadings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-33
ii Siemens Energy, Inc., Power Technologies International
PSSE 32.0
Table of Contents
3.6.14 Multi-Section Line Reporting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-33 3.6.15 Item Annotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-34 3.6.16 Contouring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-39 3.6.17 Customizing Tooltips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-45 3.7 3.8 Using Auto-Draw . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-46 3.7.1 3.8.1 3.8.2 3.8.3 3.8.4 3.9 3.9.1 Bus Orientation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-48 Power Flow Annotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-50 Range Checking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-52 Adding a Summation Record . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-56 Adding a Report Node . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-57 Impedance Annotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-60 Displaying Power Flow Results . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-49
3.10 Displaying Graphical Difference Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-61 Activity GDIF 3.10.1 Comparison Annotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-63 3.11 Displaying ASCC Fault Analysis Results . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-64 3.11.1 Fault Analysis Data Annotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-64 3.12 Displaying IEC Fault Analysis Results . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-65 3.12.1 IEC Fault Analysis Annotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-65 3.13 Displaying Reliability Analysis Results . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-66 3.13.1 Reliability Annotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-66 3.14 Displaying Dynamics Analysis Results . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-69 3.14.1 Dynamics Annotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-71 3.15 Creating a Bus Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-72 Activity GOUT/GEXM 3.15.1 Single Bus Display Labels and Symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-74 3.15.2 Navigating the Network Using the Single Bus Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-76 3.15.3 Converting Grow Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-77 3.16 Generating a Graphical Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-78 Activity GRPG 3.17 Diagram Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-80 3.17.1 Diagram Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-80 3.17.2 Errors/Missing Items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-80 3.17.3 Diagram Layers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-81 3.17.4 Property Overrides . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-84 3.17.5 Cleaning the Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-84
iii
3.18 Exporting Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-85 3.18.1 Image File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-85 3.18.2 Bus Location File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-85 3.18.3 Google Earth Locations File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-85 3.19 Closing the Diagram View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-86
Chapter 5 - Tools
5.1 5.2 5.3 Customizing Toolbars . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-1 Configuring Custom Toolbar Buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3 Creating Custom Toolbars . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5
Reading / Changing Power Flow Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6 Activity RDCH Selecting Extended Bus Name Input Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-8 Adding Machine Impedance Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-9 Activity MCRE Reading Sequence Data for Fault Analysis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10 Activity RESQ
iv
PSSE 32.0
Table of Contents
5.8 5.9
Reading Transactions Raw Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-11 Activity REMM Managing Case Titles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-12 5.9.1 5.9.2 Importing a Long Title . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-12 Activity RETI Changing the Case Title and the Long Title . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-13 Activity CHTI
6.10 Changing Adjustment Enable Flags of Transformers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-32 Activity TFLG 6.11 Importing an ECDI Data File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-33 6.12 Performing Unit Commitment and Economic Dispatch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-34 Activity ECDI 6.13 Changing Area Assignments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-36 Activity ARNM Activity LDAR
6.14 Changing Owner Assignments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-38 Activity OWNM 6.15 Changing Zone Assignments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-40 Activity ZONM Activity LDZO 6.16 Renumbering Buses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-43 Activity BSNM 6.16.1 Renumbering Buses by Bus Number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-43 File Input 6-44 Dialog Input 6-44 6.16.2 Renumbering Buses by Name . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-45 File Input 6-45 Dialog Input 6-45 6.16.3 Renumbering Buses by Packing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-46 6.16.4 Renumbering Buses By Subsystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-47 All Buses Without Area Blocking 6-47 All Buses With Area Blocking 6-48 Subsystem Bus Number Range 6-48 Subsystem Bus Number Offset 6-49 6.17 Renumbering Buses in Auxiliary Data Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-50 Activity RNFI 6.18 Changing Sequence Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-52 Activity SQCH
vi
PSSE 32.0
Table of Contents
System Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-11 Activity SIZE Saved Case and Snapshot Filenames . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-12 Activity SHOW Unused Bus Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-13 Activity BUSN
vii
10.2.4 Newton-Raphson Power Flow Solution with Inertial / Governor Dispatch . 10-14 Activity INLF 10.2.5 Gauss-Seidel Power Flow Solution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-17 Activity SOLV 10.2.6 Modified Gauss-Seidel Power Flow Solution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-20 Activity MSLV 10.3 Running AC Contingency Analysis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-22 Activity ACCC 10.4 AC Corrective Actions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-25 10.5 Running Multi-Level Contingency Analysis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-27 10.6 Generation Dispatch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-31 10.7 PV Analysis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-33 10.7.1 Implementing a Specific PV Transfer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-41 10.7.2 PV Analysis Using Previous Results . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-42 10.8 QV Analysis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-43 10.8.1 QV Analysis Using Previous Results . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-47 10.9 Running Probabilistic Reliability Assessment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-48 10.10 Running Substation Reliability Assessment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-51
viii
PSSE 32.0
Table of Contents
12.4 Creating Configuration Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12-8 12.4.1 Subsystem Description File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12-10 12.4.2 Monitored Element Description File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12-10 12.4.3 Contingency Description FIle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12-10 12.5 Running the DC Linearized Network Solution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12-11 Activity DCLF 12.6 Calculating Linearized Network Contingency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12-13 Activity DCCC 12.7 Running DC Corrective Action Analysis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12-15 12.8 Calculating Transmission Interchange Limits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12-16 Activity TLTG 12.9 Calculating Sequential Participation Interchange Limits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12-20 Activity SPIL 12.10 Running Interchange Limit Analysis with Two Opposing Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . .12-25 Activity POLY 12.10.1 Interchange Limit Calculations using Previous Results . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12-30 12.11 Running Midwest MW-mile Calculation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12-31 Activity MWMI
ix
14.4 Calculating Automatic Sequencing Fault . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-8 Activity ASCC 14.5 Calculating Fault Currents to ANSI Standards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-10 Activity ANSI 14.6 Using Classical Fault Analysis Option . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-13 Activity FLAT 14.7 Calculating Short Circuit Currents According to IEC 60909 Standard . . . . . . . . . . 14-14 Activity IECS 14.8 Calculating Circuit Breaker Interrupting Duty . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-16 Activity BKDY 14.9 Calculating pi-Equivalent, Single Transmission Line Unbalance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-18 Activity SPCB
PSSE 32.0
Table of Contents
15.3.5 Summarizing Load Reduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-24 Activity LODR 15.4 Limit Checking Reports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-26 15.4.1 Machine Reactive Capability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-27 Activity GCAP 15.4.2 Generator Bus Limits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-28 Activity GENS 15.4.3 Machine Terminal Limits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-29 Activity GEOL 15.4.4 Branch Overloads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-30 Activity RAT3 15.4.5 Transmission Line Overloads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-31 Activity OLTL 15.4.6 Transformer Overloads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-32 Activity OLTR 15.4.7 Branch Current Ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-33 Activity RATE 15.4.8 Voltage Controlled Buses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-34 Activity REGB 15.4.9 Controlling Transformers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-35 Activity TLST 15.4.10 Out-of-limit Bus Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-36 Activity VCHK 15.5 AC Contingency Reports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-37 15.5.1 ACCC Post Processor (AcccBrwsGrid) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-39 15.5.2 Appending to ACCC Output File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-40 15.6 Multiple AC Contingency Run Reports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-42 15.7 Reporting DC Network Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-44 Activity MTDC 15.8 Restricting the Output of Large Reports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-46 15.8.1 By Area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-46 15.8.2 By Owner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-47 15.8.3 By Zone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-48 15.9 Exporting Power Flow Results to Microsoft Excel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-49
xi
xii
PSSE 32.0
Table of Contents
18.2.7 Branch Flow Spreadsheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-8 18.2.8 Branch Flow / Subsystem Spreadsheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-9 18.2.9 Adjustable Bus Load Spreadsheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-11 18.2.10 Adjustable Bus Load / Subsystem Spreadsheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-12 18.2.11 Adjustable Load Table Spreadsheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-13 18.2.12 Generator Dispatch Spreadsheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-13 18.2.13 Generator Dispatch / Subsystem Spreadsheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-14 18.2.14 Active Power Dispatch Table Spreadsheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-15 18.2.15 Generation Reactive Capability Spreadsheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-16 18.2.16 Generation Reactive Capability / Subsystem Spreadsheet . . . . . . . . . . . .18-16 18.2.17 Generation Reserve Spreadsheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-17 18.2.18 Generation Reserve / Subsystem Spreadsheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-18 18.3 OPF Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-19 18.3.1 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-20 18.3.2 Objectives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-21 18.3.3 Tolerances . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-22 18.3.4 Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-23 18.3.5 Reporting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-24 18.4 Running the Optimal Power Flow Solution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-27 Activity NOPF 18.5 Displaying OPF Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-29 Activity LSTO 18.6 Data Tables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-30 18.6.1 Linear Cost Tables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-31 18.6.2 Quadratic Cost Tables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-33 18.6.3 Polynomial and Exponential Cost Tables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-34 18.6.4 Period Reserve Constraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-35 18.6.5 Interface Flow Constraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-36 18.6.6 Linear Constraint Dependencies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-37 18.7 Creating an Optimal Power Flow Raw Data File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-38 Activity RWOP
xiii
19.4 Channel Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-6 19.5 Assigning Output Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-8 19.5.1 Simulation Variables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-8 Activity CHAN Bus Quantity Line Quantity Load Quantity Machine Quantity Miscellaneous Quantity 19-9 19-11 19-12 19-13 19-15
19.5.2 Subsystem Simulation Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-16 Activity CHSB 19.6 Saving Dynamics Working Memory in a Binary FIle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-19 Activity SNAP 19.7 Listing Snapshot Filenames . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-20 Activity SHOW 19.8 Modifying Data in Dynamics Working Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-21 Activity ALTR 19.9 Modifying Dynamics Model Pointer Tables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-23 Activity DYCH 19.10 Creating a Dynamics Model Raw Data File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-25 Activity DYDA 19.11 Creating Dynamic Data Records for Use by Other Activities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-27 Activity RWDY 19.12 Listing Dynamics Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-29 19.12.1 Model Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-29 Activity DOCU 19.12.2 Data Arrays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-31 Activity DLST 19.12.3 Model Storage Locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-33 Activity MLST 19.13 Dumping Dynamic Simulation Output Channels into a Response File . . . . . . . . . 19-35 Activity DMPC 19.14 Defining Model Search Paths . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-36
xiv
PSSE 32.0
Table of Contents
20.4 Running Exciter Simulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20-8 Activity ESTR/ERUN 20.4.1 Exciter Simulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20-8 20.4.2 Exciter Response Ratio Simulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20-10 20.5 Running Governor Response Simulation Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20-13 Activity GSTR/GRUN 20.6 Running Extended Term Dynamic Simulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20-16 Activity MSTR/MRUN 20.7 Applying Disturbances . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20-19 20.7.1 Bus Fault . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20-19 20.7.2 Line Fault . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20-20 20.7.3 Clear Fault . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20-21 20.7.4 Trip Line . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20-22 20.7.5 Close Line . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20-23 20.7.6 Disconnect Bus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20-23 20.7.7 Disconnect Machine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20-24 20.7.8 Change Vref . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20-25 20.7.9 Change Gref . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20-26 20.7.10 Unbalanced Bus Fault . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20-27 20.7.11 Branch Unbalance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20-28 20.8 Launching NEVA Eigenvalue Analysis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20-31 20.9 Building a State Variable Matrix for Linear Dynamic Analysis (LSYSAN) . . . . . . . .20-32 Activity ASTR
xv
Creating a Plot Changing Plot Properties Deleting Plots Copying Plots to the Clipboard Plot Attribute Dialogs Plot Title Dialog Plot Legend Dialog Plot Series Dialog Plot Axis Dialog Plot Background Dialog Plot Annotation Dialog Multiple Y Axes CrossHair Cursor
21-10 21-10 21-10 21-10 21-11 21-11 21-13 21-15 21-17 21-19 21-20 21-21 21-22
21.3.3 Plot Editor Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-23 Chart / Series Controls 21-25 Chart / Axis Controls 21-26 Chart / Titles Controls 21-27 Series Controls 21-27 Data Control 21-28 Export / Picture Control 21-29 Export / Data Control 21-30
xvi
PSSE 32.0
Table of Contents
Chapter 26 - Scenarios
25.1 Creating a Scenario File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25-1 25.2 Building a Scenario . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25-1 25.3 Opening an Existing Scenario File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25-4 25.4 Closing a Scenario File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25-4
xvii
xviii
List of Figures
Figure 1-1. Figure 1-2. Figure 1-3. Figure 1-4. Figure 1-5. Figure 1-6. Figure 1-7. Figure 2-1. Figure 2-2. Figure 2-3. Figure 2-4. Figure 2-5. Figure 2-6. Figure 2-7. Figure 2-8. Figure 2-9. Figure 2-10. Figure 2-11. Figure 2-12. Figure 2-13. Figure 2-14. Figure 2-15. Figure 2-16. Figure 2-17. Figure 2-18. Figure 3-1. Figure 3-2. Figure 3-3. Figure 3-4. Figure 3-5. Figure 3-6. Figure 3-7. Figure 3-8. Figure 3-9. Properties Dialog. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4 Program Preferences Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6 Program Settings Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-11 Key Elements of the Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-14 View Activation Buttons. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-15 Command Line Interface Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-16 New and Build New Case Dialogs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-17 Spreadsheet View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1 Spreadsheet Column Right-Click Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4 Cells Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5 Spreadsheet Header / Footer Dialog. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6 Spreadsheet Page Setup Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7 Print Setup Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8 Network Spreadsheet View, Bus Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9 Creating a Bus Subsystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10 Bus Subsystem Selector Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-11 Filter Bus Subsystem Selection Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-12 OPF Spreadsheet View. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-14 Dynamics Spreadsheet View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-16 Dynamics Spreadsheet Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-17 Edit Model Parameters Dialog. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-17 Model Selection Dialog, Generator Models. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-18 Dynamics Data Tab. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-19 Models Spreadsheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-20 Event Spreadsheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-21 Diagram View with Slider Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2 Diagram Properties Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3 Color Dialog. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4 Font Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4 Select Directory for Image Files Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6 Example: Automatic Bus Numbering. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-7 Adding Buses to the Database Using the Diagram View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-8 Adding Network Elements to the Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10 Image Properties Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-12
xix
List of Figures
Figure 3-10. Figure 3-11. Figure 3-12. Figure 3-13. Figure 3-14. Figure 3-15. Figure 3-16. Figure 3-17. Figure 3-18. Figure 3-19. Figure 3-20. Figure 3-21. Figure 3-22. Figure 3-23. Figure 3-24. Figure 3-25. Figure 3-26. Figure 3-27. Figure 3-28. Figure 3-29. Figure 3-30. Figure 3-31. Figure 3-32. Figure 3-33. Figure 3-34. Figure 3-35. Figure 3-36. Figure 3-37. Figure 3-38. Figure 3-39. Figure 3-40. Figure 3-41. Figure 3-42. Figure 3-43. Figure 3-44. Figure 3-45. Figure 3-46. Figure 3-47.
Diagram Template, Double Bus and Single Breaker, 4 Circuits. . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-13 Example of Diagram View Right-click Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-15 Select Bus Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-18 Make Labels Selectable Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-19 Saved Views Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-19 Impact of Auto-Positioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-20 Line Style Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-21 Customized Right-Click Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-22 Alternative Bus Symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-22 Example of Switch Function to Out-of-Service. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-23 Insert a Breaker Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-24 Insert a Switch Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-25 Moving and Resizing Buses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-29 Moving Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-30 Changing Line Status from Diagram View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-31 Examples of Transformer Symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-32 Animated Flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-32 Current Loading Blocks Indicating Flow Levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-33 Multi-Line Section Reporting ON and OFF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-33 Bus Annotation Properties Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-34 Annotation Properties Options for Shunts and Loads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-35 Branch / Two Winding Transformer Annotation Properties Dialogs . . . . . . . . . . 3-36 Three-Winding Transformer Annotation Properties Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-37 Other Annotation Properties Dialogs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-37 FACTS Device Annotation Properties Dialog. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-38 Contour Settings Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-39 6 X 6 Virtual Grid Superimposed on Contour Points P1 P6 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-40 Circle of Influence around Contour Point P1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-41 Linear Approximation Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-41 Linear Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-42 Non-Uniform Partitioning using the QuadTree Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-43 Alternative Tooltip Presentations for a Bus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-45 Drawing Bus 101 and Buses Two Levels Out, using the Auto Draw Toolbar Button 3-47
Power Flow Results in Diagram View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-49 Power Flow Data Annotation Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-50 Signs and Arrows to Display Flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-51 Diagram Range Checking Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-52 Voltage Level Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-53
xx
List of Figures
Figure 3-48. Figure 3-49. Figure 3-50. Figure 3-51. Figure 3-52. Figure 3-53. Figure 3-54. Figure 3-55. Figure 3-56. Figure 3-57. Figure 3-58. Figure 3-59. Figure 3-60. Figure 3-61. Figure 3-62. Figure 3-63. Figure 3-64. Figure 3-65. Figure 3-66. Figure 3-67. Figure 3-68. Figure 3-69. Figure 3-70. Figure 3-71. Figure 3-72. Figure 3-73. Figure 3-74. Figure 3-75. Figure 3-76. Figure 3-77. Figure 3-78. Figure 3-79. Figure 4-1. Figure 4-2. Figure 4-3. Figure 4-4. Figure 4-5. Figure 4-6. Figure 4-7.
Line Ratings Appearance Dialog. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-53 Bus Voltage Limit Appearance Dialog. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-54 Out-of-Service Equipment Appearance Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-54 Power Flow Diagram showing Effect of Range Checking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-55 Edit Summation Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-56 Example of Report Node . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-58 Example of Impedance Data in a One-Line Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-59 Impedance Data Annotation Dialog. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-60 Compare Cases on a Diagram Dialog. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-61 Example of Case Comparison Differences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-62 Graphical Case Comparison Data Annotation Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-63 ASCC Fault Analysis Annotation Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-64 IEC Fault Analysis Annotation Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-65 Reliability Analysis Annotation Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-67 Example of Branch Flow Overloading Probabilistic Reliability Results . . . . . . . 3-68 Example of Bus Load Curtailment Results . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-68 Example of Diagram View Showing Difference between Bus Display and Bus Display with Dynamic Analysis Results 3-70
Dynamics Simulation Annotation Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-71 Select Bus Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-72 Example of Single Bus Display, Power Flow Results . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-72 Example of Single Bus Display, Impedance Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-73 Scrolling through the Network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-76 Terminal Read Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-78 GRPG-Style Graphical Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-79 Diagram Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-80 Results Generated by the Check Menu Option. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-80 Layers Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-81 Status Bar Showing Active Layer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-82 Setting the Active Layer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-82 All Layers Visible from Layers Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-83 Only Default Visible . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-83 JPEG Quality Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-85 Network Tree View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1 Tree View, Buses in Active Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2 Some Tree View Menu Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3 OPF Tree View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-4 Dynamics Tree View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5 Models Tree View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-6 Plot Tree . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-7
xxi
List of Figures
Figure 5-1. Figure 5-2. Figure 5-3. Figure 5-4. Figure 5-5. Figure 5-6. Figure 5-1. Figure 5-2. Figure 5-3. Figure 5-4. Figure 5-5. Figure 6-1. Figure 6-2. Figure 6-3. Figure 6-4. Figure 6-5. Figure 6-6. Figure 6-7. Figure 6-8. Figure 6-9. Figure 6-10. Figure 6-11. Figure 6-12. Figure 6-13. Figure 6-14. Figure 6-15. Figure 6-16. Figure 6-17. Figure 6-18. Figure 6-19. Figure 6-20. Figure 6-21. Figure 6-22. Figure 6-23. Figure 6-24. Figure 6-25. Figure 6-26. Figure 6-27. Figure 6-28.
Customize Dialog, Toolbars Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-1 Customize Dialog: Commands Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2 Customize Toolbar Buttons Dialog. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3 Defined Toolbar Buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-4 Custom Toolbar Showing Defined Buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-4 New Toolbar Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5 Example of Power Flow Saved Case File Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2 Read Power Flow Raw Data Dialog, Subsystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5 Read Power Flow Raw Data Dialog, RDCH. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-7 Select Extended Bus Name Input Format Dialog. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-8 Case Titles Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-13 Inter-area Transfer Spreadsheet, Transfer MW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-2 Disconnect/Reconnect Bus Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3 Bus Selection Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4 Bus Filter Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4 Example of Disconnect Bus Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5 Example of Reconnect Bus Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5 Join Buses Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-6 Example of Join Buses Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7 Original Topology . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8 Revised Topology After Joining Buses 154 and 3008 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-9 Split Buses Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-10 Reassign Branches and Equipment Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-11 Bus 3003 to be Split . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12 Bus Selection and Reassignment for Bus Split . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12 Example of Split Buses Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-13 Diagram View of New Topology following Bus Split. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-13 Tap Line Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-15 Line Selected to be Tapped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-16 Specification of a Branch for the Tap Line . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-17 Final Stage in Tap Line Activity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-18 New Topology on Tapped Line . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-19 Inter-area Transfer Spreadsheet, Identifier . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-20 Move Network Elements Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-21 Original Topology before Moving Branch 151 - 201. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-22 Branch Selection Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-23 Bus Selection Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-24 Example of Moving a Branch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-24 New Topology Following Branch Move . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-25
xxii
List of Figures
Figure 6-29. Figure 6-30. Figure 6-31. Figure 6-32. Figure 6-33. Figure 6-34. Figure 6-35. Figure 6-36. Figure 6-37. Figure 6-38. Figure 6-39. Figure 6-40. Figure 6-41. Figure 6-42. Figure 6-43. Figure 6-44. Figure 6-45. Figure 6-46. Figure 6-47. Figure 6-48. Figure 7-1. Figure 7-2. Figure 8-1. Figure 8-2. Figure 8-3. Figure 8-4. Figure 8-5. Figure 8-6. Figure 8-7. Figure 9-1. Figure 9-2. Figure 9-3. Figure 9-4. Figure 9-5. Figure 9-6. Figure 10-1. Figure 10-2. Figure 10-3. Figure 10-4.
Deleting Network Elements Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-26 Example of Deleted Buses and the Diagram Properties Options . . . . . . . . . . . 6-27 Example of Removing Outaged Equipment Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-28 Scale Powerflow Data Dialog to Specify Subsystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-29 Scale Powerflow Data Dialog to Enter Scaling Targets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-30 Example of Scaling Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-31 Transformer Adjustment Flags Dialog. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-32 Economic Dispatch Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-34 Specify Dispatch Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-35 Renumbering Areas/Owners/Zones Dialog: Area Assignments Tab . . . . . . . . 6-37 Renumbering Areas/Owners/Zones Dialog: Owner Assignments Tab . . . . . . . 6-39 Renumbering Areas/Owners/Zones Dialog: Zone Assignments Tab . . . . . . . . 6-41 Zone Reassignment Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-42 Renumber Buses by Bus Number Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-44 Renumber Buses by Bus Name Dialog. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-45 Renumber Buses by Bus Packing Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-46 Renumber Buses by Subsystem Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-47 Example of Block Numbers By Area Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-48 Renumber Buses in Auxiliary Files Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-50 Sequence Data, Fixed Shunt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-52 List Data Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-2 File Information Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-10 Compare Case Totals Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2 Example of Compare Case Totals Report. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2 Compare Power Flow Cases Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-3 Select Powerflow Comparison Options Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-4 Example of Compare Cases Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-5 Compare Tie Lines Dialog. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-6 Select Tie Line Comparison Options Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-7 Save Network Data Dialog, Case Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-2 Save Network Data Dialog, IEEE Common Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-4 Save Network Data Dialog, Machine Impedance Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-6 Save Network Data Dialog, Power Flow Raw Data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-8 Save Network Data Dialog, Sequence Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-10 Save Network Data Dialog, Transaction Data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-12 Power Flow Solution Parameters Dialog. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-2 Power Flow Solution Parameters Dialog, Gauss . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-3 Power Flow Solution Parameters Dialog, Newton. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-4 Loadflow Solutions Dialog, Newton-Raphson, Decoupled . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-6
xxiii
List of Figures
Figure 10-5. Figure 10-6. Figure 10-7. Figure 10-8. Figure 10-9.
Example of Newton-Raphson Decoupled Solution Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-7 Loadflow Solutions Dialog, Newton-Raphson, Fully-Coupled . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-9 Example of Newton-Raphson Fully-Coupled Solution Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-10 Loadflow Solutions Dialog, Newton-Raphson, Fixed Slope Decoupled . . . . . . 10-12 Example of Newton-Raphson Fixed Slope Decoupled Solution Output. . . . . . 10-13
Figure 10-10. N-R Solution with Inertial / Governor Redispatch Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-15 Figure 10-11. Example of Newton-Raphson Solution with Governor Redispatch . . . . . . . . . 10-16 Figure 10-12. Loadflow Solutions Dialog, Gauss-Seidel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-18 Figure 10-13. Example of Gauss-Seidel Solution Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-19 Figure 10-14. Loadflow Solutions Dialog, Modified Gauss-Seidel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-21 Figure 10-15. AC Contingency Solution Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-23 Figure 10-16. Example of AC Contingency Solution Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-24 Figure 10-17. Example of AC Corrective Actions Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-25 Figure 10-18. AC Corrective Actions Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-26 Figure 10-19. Multi-Level AC Contingency Solution Dialog, Power Flow Control . . . . . . . . . 10-27 Figure 10-20. Multi-Level AC Contingency Solution Dialog, Multiple Contingency Analysis . 10-28 Figure 10-21. Multi-Level AC Contingency Solution Dialog, Tripping Simulation . . . . . . . . . . 10-29 Figure 10-22. Multi-Level AC Contingency Solution Dialog, Corrective Actions. . . . . . . . . . . 10-30 Figure 10-23. Implement Generation Dispatch Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-31 Figure 10-24. Example of Generation Dispatch Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-32 Figure 10-25. PV Analysis Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-34 Figure 10-26. Example of PV Analysis, Partial Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-35 Figure 10-27. PV Results Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-36 Figure 10-28. Graph Area Visual Parameters Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-37 Figure 10-29. Vertical Scale Adjustment Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-38 Figure 10-30. Horizontal Scale Adjustment Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-39 Figure 10-31. Print Settings Dialog. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-39 Figure 10-32. PV Results, Graphics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-40 Figure 10-33. Implement PV Transfer Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-41 Figure 10-34. PV Parameters Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-42 Figure 10-35. QV Analysis Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-43 Figure 10-36. Example of QV Analysis, Partial Output. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-44 Figure 10-37. QV Results Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-45 Figure 10-38. QV Results, Graphics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-46 Figure 10-39. QV Parameters Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-47 Figure 10-40. Probabilistic Reliability Assessment Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-49 Figure 10-41. Probabilistic Reliability Assessment Output, System Problem Summary, Post Contingency 10-50
xxiv
List of Figures
Figure 11-1. Figure 11-2. Figure 11-3. Figure 11-4. Figure 11-5. Figure 11-6. Figure 11-7. Figure 11-8. Figure 12-1. Figure 12-2. Figure 12-3. Figure 12-4. Figure 12-5. Figure 12-6. Figure 12-7. Figure 12-8. Figure 12-9.
Check Branch Parameters Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-2 Check/Change Controlled Bus Scheduled Voltages Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-3 Change Voltage Setpoint Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-4 Change Vmin/Vmax Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-4 Check/Change Transformer Adjustment Data Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-6 Change Transformer Tap Step Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-6 Change Transformer Flow Band Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-7 Example Dialog of Activity TREE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-8 Build Distribution Factor Data File Dialog (EXAMPLE Input Files) . . . . . . . . . . 12-1 Example of Output from Building the Distribution Factor Data File . . . . . . . . . . 12-2 Example of OTDF Contingency Summaries (pages 1 and 3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-3 Example of OTDF Distribution Factor Tables (pages 2 and 4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-4 Single Contingency Ranking Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-6 Example of Single Contingency Ranking Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-6 Configuration File Builder Dialog. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-9 DC Network Solution and Report Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-11 Example of DC Network Solution Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-12
Figure 12-10. DC Contingency Checking Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-13 Figure 12-11. Network Contingency Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-14 Figure 12-12. DC Corrective Actions Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-15 Figure 12-13. Transmission Interchange Limits Calculation Dialog. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-17 Figure 12-14. Example of Export Limit Summary Report (page 1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-18 Figure 12-15. Example of Export Limit Summary Report (page 2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-18 Figure 12-16. Example of Export Limit Summary Report (page 3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-19 Figure 12-17. Example of Export Limit Summary Report (page 4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-19 Figure 12-18. Sequential Participation Interchange Limit Dialog. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-21 Figure 12-19. Sequential Participation Interchange Limit Activity Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-22 Figure 12-20. Example of Export Limit Report (page 1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-22 Figure 12-21. Example of Export Limit Report, Base Case (page 2). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-23 Figure 12-22. Example of Export Limit, Partial Report (page 3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-23 Figure 12-23. Example of Export Limit Report (page 4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-24 Figure 12-24. Interchange Limits with Two Opposing Systems Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-26 Figure 12-25. Interchange Limits with Two Opposing Systems Activity Output . . . . . . . . . . 12-27 Figure 12-26. Example of Export Limit Report (page 1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-27 Figure 12-27. Example of Export Limit Report (page 2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-28 Figure 12-28. Example of Export Limit Report (page 3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-28 Figure 12-29. Example of Poly Plotting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-29 Figure 12-30. POLY Parameters Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-30 Figure 13-1. Equivalence Networks Dialog, Build Electrical Equivalent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-2
xxv
List of Figures
Figure 13-2. Figure 13-3. Figure 13-4. Figure 13-5. Figure 13-6. Figure 13-7. Figure 14-1. Figure 14-2. Figure 14-3. Figure 14-4. Figure 14-5. Figure 14-6. Figure 14-7. Figure 14-8. Figure 14-9.
Example of Build Electrical Equivalent Activity Output. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-2 Equivalence Networks Dialog, Net Generation with Load . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-3 Equivalence Networks Dialog, Equivalence Radial Buses. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-4 Equivalence Networks Dialog, Net Boundary Mismatches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-5 Equivalence Networks Dialog, Build Three Sequence Equivalent . . . . . . . . . . . 13-6 Example of Build Three Sequence Equivalent Activity Output. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-7 Setup Network for Unbalanced Solution Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-1 Example of Unbalanced Fault Analysis Setup Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-2 Multiple Simultaneous Unbalances Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-4 Example of Multiple Simultaneous Unbalances Activity Output with Network Setup Option Selected 14-4
Example of Multiple Simultaneous Unbalances Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-5 Multiple Unbalanced Solution Output Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-6 Detailed Fault Analysis, Partial Report. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-7 Automatic Sequence Fault Calculation Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-9 ANSI Fault Current Calculation Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-11
Figure 14-10. Add Bus Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-12 Figure 14-11. Example of ANSI Fault Current Calculation Activity Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-12 Figure 14-12. Example of ANSI Fault Current Calculation Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-12 Figure 14-13. Setup for Special Fault Calculations Dialog, Classical Fault Analysis . . . . . . . 14-13 Figure 14-14. IEC 60909 Fault Calculation Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-15 Figure 14-15. Circuit Breaker Interrupting Duty Dialog. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-16 Figure 14-16. Example of Circuit Breaker Interrupting Duty Activity Output. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-17 Figure 14-17. Example of Circuit Breaker Interrupting Duty Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-17 Figure 14-18. Separate Pole Circuit Breaker Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-19 Figure 14-19. Example of Separate Pole Circuit Breaker Activity Output. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-20 Figure 14-20. Example of Separate Pole Circuit Breaker Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-20 Figure 15-1. Figure 15-2. Figure 15-3. Figure 15-4. Figure 15-5. Figure 15-6. Figure 15-7. Figure 15-8. Figure 15-9. Area/Zone Based Reports Dialog, Area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-2 Example of Area Interchange Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-2 Area/Zone Based Reports Dialog, Zone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-3 Example of Zone Interchange Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-4 Area/Zone Based Reports Dialog, Area Tie Line Loadings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-5 Example of Area Tie Line Loadings Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-6 Area/Zone Based Reports Dialog, Zone Tie Line Loadings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-7 Example of Zone Tie Line Loadings Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-8 Area/Owner/Zone Totals Dialog, Area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-9
Figure 15-10. Example of Area Totals Report with Zone Subtotals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-10 Figure 15-11. Area/Owner/Zone Totals Dialog, Owner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-11 Figure 15-12. Example of Owner Totals Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-12
xxvi
List of Figures
Figure 15-13. Area/Owner/Zone Totals Dialog, Zone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-13 Figure 15-14. Example of Zone Totals Report. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-14 Figure 15-15. Bus Based Reports Dialog, Standard Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-16 Figure 15-16. Example of Standard Format Power Flow Solution Report. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-17 Figure 15-17. Bus Based Reports Dialog, Wide Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-18 Figure 15-18. Example of Wide Format Power Flow Solution Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-19 Figure 15-19. Bus Based Reports Dialog, Wide Format, with Branch Current Loadings . . . 15-20 Figure 15-20. Example of Wide Format Power Flow Solution Report with Branch Current Loadings 15-21
Figure 15-21. Bus Based Reports Dialog, Subsystem Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-22 Figure 15-22. Example of Subsystem Summary Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-23 Figure 15-23. Bus Based Reports Dialog, Load Reduction Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-24 Figure 15-24. Limit Checking Reports Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-26 Figure 15-25. Example of Reactive Capability Report. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-27 Figure 15-26. Example of Generator Bus Report, On-line Plants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-28 Figure 15-27. Example of Machine Terminal Limits Report, Overloaded Machines Only . . . 15-29 Figure 15-28. Example of Branch Overload Report, Default Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-30 Figure 15-29. Example of Transmission Line Overload Report, Rate C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-31 Figure 15-30. Example of Transformer Overload Report, Default Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-32 Figure 15-31. Example of Branch Current Ratings Report, Default Option . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-33 Figure 15-32. Example of Regulated Buses Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-34 Figure 15-33. Example of Controlling Transformer Report, Violations Only . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-35 Figure 15-34. Example of Out-of-Limit Bus Voltage Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-36 Figure 15-35. AC Contingency Reports Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-38 Figure 15-36. Example of Available Capacity Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-39 Figure 15-37. Append to AC Contingency Solution Output File Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-41 Figure 15-38. Multiple AC Contingency Run Report Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-43 Figure 15-39. Example of DC Network Conditions Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-44 Figure 15-40. Area Subsystem Selector Dialog. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-46 Figure 15-41. Owner Subsystem Selector Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-47 Figure 15-42. Zone Subsystem Selector Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-48 Figure 15-43. Specify psseexcel.accc Options Dialog. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-49 Figure 15-44. Export Data/Result to Excel Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-50 Figure 16-1. Figure 16-2. Figure 16-3. Figure 16-4. Figure 16-5. Figure 16-6. Figure 17-1. Convert / Reconstruct Loads and Generators Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-1 Order Network Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-5 Output the Network Admittance Matrix Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-6 Example of Exported Network Admittance Matrix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-7 Solution for Switching Studies Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-8 Example of Switching Studies Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-9 Transaction Data Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-1
xxvii
List of Figures
Figure 17-2. Figure 17-3. Figure 17-4. Figure 17-5. Figure 17-6. Figure 17-7. Figure 17-8. Figure 18-1. Figure 18-2. Figure 18-3. Figure 18-4. Figure 18-5. Figure 18-6. Figure 18-7. Figure 18-8. Figure 18-9.
Impact on Monitored Elements Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-2 Line Loading Relief by Transaction Adjustment Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-4 Example of Line Loading Relief Report: Transaction Curtailment . . . . . . . . . . . 17-4 Megawatt Shift Factors Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-5 Example of Vector Absolute MW-ohm Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-6 Example of Vector Sum MW-ohm Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-6 Example of Branch Mileage by Owner Summary. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-6 OPF Initialization Pop-up Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-2 Example of Bus Attribute Data Changed by OPF Data File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-2 Example of Bus Voltage Spreadsheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-3 Bus Voltage Subsystem Spreadsheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-4 Example of Adjustable Bus Shunt Spreadsheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-5 Adjustable Bus Shunt Subsystem Spreadsheet. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-5 Example of Adjustable Branch Reactance Spreadsheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-7 Adjustable Branch Reactance Subsystem Spreadsheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-7 Example of Branch Flow Spreadsheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-8
Figure 18-10. Branch Flow Subsystem Spreadsheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-9 Figure 18-11. Example of Adjustable Bus Load Spreadsheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-11 Figure 18-12. Adjustable Bus Load Subsystem Spreadsheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-12 Figure 18-13. Example of Adjustable Load Table Spreadsheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-13 Figure 18-14. Example of Generator Dispatch Spreadsheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-13 Figure 18-15. Generator Dispatch Subsystem Spreadsheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-14 Figure 18-16. Example of Active Power Dispatch Table Spreadsheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-15 Figure 18-17. Example of Generation Reactive Capability Spreadsheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-16 Figure 18-18. Generation Reactive Capability Subsystem Spreadsheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-16 Figure 18-19. Example of Generation Reserve Spreadsheet. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-17 Figure 18-20. Generation Reserve Subsystem Spreadsheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-18 Figure 18-21. OPF - Change Parameters Dialog, General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-20 Figure 18-22. OPF - Change Parameters Dialog, Objectives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-21 Figure 18-23. OPF - Change Parameters Dialog, Tolerances . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-22 Figure 18-24. OPF - Change Parameters Dialog, Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-23 Figure 18-25. OPF - Change Parameters Dialog, Reporting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-24 Figure 18-26. Example of Optimization Log . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-25 Figure 18-27. Example of Detailed Optimization Log (Partial) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-26 Figure 18-28. OPF Solution Dialog. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-27 Figure 18-29. Example of OPF Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-28 Figure 18-30. Example of Piece-wise Linear Cost Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-31 Figure 18-31. Vertical Scale Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-32 Figure 18-32. Horizontal Scale Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-32
xxviii
List of Figures
Figure 18-33. Example of Piece-wise Quadratic Cost Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-33 Figure 18-34. Default Polynomial and Exponential Cost Table Spreadsheet . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-34 Figure 18-35. Example of Period Reserve Constraints Record. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-35 Figure 18-36. Example of Interface Flow Constraints Record . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-36 Figure 18-37. Example of Linear Constraint Dependencies Record . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-37 Figure 18-38. Save Network Data Dialog, Optimal Power Flow Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-39 Figure 19-1. Figure 19-2. Figure 19-3. Figure 19-4. Figure 19-5. Figure 19-6. Figure 19-7. Figure 19-8. Figure 19-9. Read Raw Format Dynamics Data Dialog. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-2 Example of Read Raw Format Dynamics Data Summary Output. . . . . . . . . . . 19-2 Read Raw Format Dynamics Data Dialog when Adding Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-3 Channel Setup Wizard Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-6 Example of Channel Setup Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-7 Assign Channels for Bus Quantities Dialog. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-9 Example of Bus Channel Assignment Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-9 Channel Output Assignments in Tree View. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-10 Assign Channels for Line Quantities Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-11
Figure 19-10. Assign Channels for Load Quantities Dialog. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-12 Figure 19-11. Machine Selection Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-13 Figure 19-12. Assign Channels for Machine Quantities Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-14 Figure 19-13. Assign Channels for Miscellaneous Quantities Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-15 Figure 19-14. Select Channels by Subsystem Dialog, Tie Line. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-17 Figure 19-15. Example of Channel Assignment by Subsystem Output. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-17 Figure 19-16. Save / Show Dynamics Snapshot Data Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-19 Figure 19-17. Example of Dynamic Snapshot File Report. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-20 Figure 19-18. Example of Dynamics Spreadsheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-22 Figure 19-19. Model Maintenance Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-24 Figure 19-20. Save / Show Dynamics Data Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-25 Figure 19-21. Save / Show Machine Parametric Source Data Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-27 Figure 19-22. List Dynamics Model Data Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-29 Figure 19-23. Example of Dynamics Model Data Checking Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-30 Figure 19-24. List Dynamics Data Common Dialog. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-31 Figure 19-25. Example of Dynamics Data Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-32 Figure 19-26. List Model Storage Locations Dialog. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-34 Figure 19-27. Example of Model Storage Locations Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-34 Figure 19-28. Save / Show Dump Output Channels Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-35 Figure 19-29. Define Model Search Paths. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-36 Figure 19-30. Add a New Directory to the Search List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-37 Figure 19-31. New Search Item. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-37 Figure 20-1. Figure 20-2. Dynamic Solution Parameters Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-2 Dynamic Simulation Options Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-4
xxix
List of Figures
Figure 20-3. Figure 20-4. Figure 20-5. Figure 20-6. Figure 20-7. Figure 20-8. Figure 20-9.
Perform Dynamic Simulation Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-6 Example of Dynamic Simulation Initial Conditions Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-6 Example of Dynamic Simulation Run Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-6 Perform Exciter Simulation Test Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-9 Example of Exciter Simulation Initialization Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-9 Example of Exciter Simulation Run Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-10 Perform Exciter Response Ratio Simulation Test Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-11
Figure 20-10. Example of Exciter Response Ratio Simulation Initialization Output . . . . . . . . 20-12 Figure 20-11. Example of Exciter Response Ratio Simulation Run Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-12 Figure 20-12. Perform Governor Response Simulation Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-14 Figure 20-13. Example of Governor Response Simulation Initialization Output. . . . . . . . . . . 20-14 Figure 20-14. Example of Governor Response Simulation Run Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-15 Figure 20-15. Perform Extended Term Dynamic Simulation Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-17 Figure 20-16. Example of Extended Term Simulation Initialization Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-17 Figure 20-17. Example of Extended Term Simulation Run Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-18 Figure 20-18. Apply a Bus Fault Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-19 Figure 20-19. Apply a Line Fault Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-20 Figure 20-20. Clear Fault Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-21 Figure 20-21. Example of Clear Fault Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-22 Figure 20-22. Trip a Line Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-22 Figure 20-23. Close a Tripped LIne Dialog. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-23 Figure 20-24. Disconnect a Bus Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-24 Figure 20-25. Example of Disconnect a Bus Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-24 Figure 20-26. Disconnect a Machine Dialog. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-24 Figure 20-27. AVR Reference (VREF) Change Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-25 Figure 20-28. Governor Reference (GREF) Change Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-26 Figure 20-29. Calculate and Apply a Bus Fault Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-27 Figure 20-30. Example of Dynamic Bus Fault Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-28 Figure 20-31. Calculate and Apply Branch Unbalance Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-29 Figure 20-32. Example of Dynamic Line Fault Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-30 Figure 20-33. Build Matrices for LSYSAN Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-33 Figure 20-34. Example of LSYSAN Matrix-Building Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-34 Figure 21-1. Figure 21-2. Figure 21-3. Figure 21-4. Figure 21-5. Figure 21-6. Figure 21-7. PlotBook with Two PlotPages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-2 Default PlotBook Layout. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-3 New PlotBook Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-4 Opening a Channel Output File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-5 PlotPackage File Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-7 PlotPackage Edit Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-9 Plot Preference Dialog, PlotBook Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-10
xxx
List of Figures
Figure 21-10. Plot Legend Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-13 Figure 21-11. Plot Series Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-15 Figure 21-12. Plot Axes Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-17 Figure 21-13. Plot Background Dialog. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-19 Figure 21-14. Plot Annotation Dialog. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-20 Figure 21-15. Multiple Y Axes in Edit Menu. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-21 Figure 21-16. Displaying CrossHair on a Plot . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-22 Figure 21-17. Accessing Plot Editor via Context Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-23 Figure 21-18. Plot Editor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-24 Figure 21-19. Change Series Title. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-25 Figure 21-20. Change Scales of Axis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-26 Figure 21-21. Add or Remove Axis Grid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-26 Figure 21-22. Chart / Titles Editing Dialog. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-27 Figure 21-23. Format Tab for Series Editing Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-27 Figure 21-24. Getting Plot X and Y Values from Data Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-28 Figure 21-25. Export Picture using Plot Editor Export . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-29 Figure 21-26. Export Data to Excel File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-30 Figure 22-1. Figure 22-2. Figure 22-3. Figure 22-4. Figure 22-5. Figure 23-1. Figure 23-2. Figure 24-1. Figure 24-2. Figure 24-3. Figure 24-4. Figure 24-5. Figure 24-6. Figure 24-7. Figure 24-8. Figure 24-9. Created Response File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22-2 Select Program Automation File Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22-4 Terminal Read Dialog for Automated Activity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22-5 Automation Arguments Dialog. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22-7 Insert Text into the Progress Stream Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22-9 Report Output Destination Selector. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-2 Define PATH Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-4 Event Study Properties Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-1 Event Item Properties Dialog. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-4 Example of Event Study Item List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-5 Create a Bus Fault Event Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-5 Create an Unbalanced Bus Fault Event Dialog. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-6 Create a Connect Bus Event Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-6 Create a Disconnect Bus Event Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-6 Create a Line Fault Event Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-7 Create an Unbalanced Line Fault Event Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-7
Figure 24-10. Create a Line Tripping Event Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-8 Figure 24-11. Create a Line Closing Event Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-8 Figure 24-12. Create a Disconnect Load Event Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-9 Figure 24-13. Create a Connect Load Event Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-9
xxxi
List of Figures
Figure 24-14. Create a Vref Change Event Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-9 Figure 24-15. Create a Gref Change Event Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-10 Figure 24-16. Create a Disconnect Machine Event Dialog. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-10 Figure 24-17. Create a Connect Machine Event Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-10 Figure 24-18. Example of Running a Dynamic Event Study . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-12 Figure 24-19. Example of Short Circuit Event Study Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-13 Figure 24-20. Example of Running a Short Circuit Event Study. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-14 Figure 25-1. Figure 25-2. Figure B-1. Figure B-2. Figure B-3. Figure B-4. Figure B-5. Figure B-6. Figure B-7. Figure B-8. Figure B-9. Scenario Editor Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-2 Select a File to Add to the Scenario Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-2 Bus Data Records . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-2 Machine Data Records. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-3 Load Data Record . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-4 Fixed Shunt Data Records . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-5 Switched Shunt Data Record, Power Flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-6 Switched Shunt Data Record, Short Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-7 Branch Data Record, Power Flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-8 Branch Data Record, Short Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-9 Two Winding Transformer Data Record, Power Flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-10
Figure B-10. Two Winding Transformer Data Record, Short Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-11
xxxii
Chapter 1
Introduction
1.1 Overview
The Siemens PTI Power System Simulator (PSSE) is a package of programs for studies of power system transmission network and generation performance in both steady-state and dynamic conditions. PSSE handles power flow, fault analysis (balanced and unbalanced), network equivalent construction, and dynamic simulation. Using PSSE, the engineer can handle a wide range of investigations for the planning and operation of modern electric power systems. The PSSE Program Operation Manual is a comprehensive working guide to PSSEs capabilities. It documents: The operation and behavior of the various functional modules available in PSSE. The formats of the various input data files read by PSSE. The output produced by PSSEs functional modules
This manual, the PSSE GUI Users Guide, describes the operation of PSSE through its Graphical User Interface (GUI). The GUI is the primary interface to PSSE; it is also the interface through which new users are first exposed to PSSE. This manual is structured to help the user become familiar with the available tools and the manner in which they can be used for power system analytical investigations. It liberally references the PSSE Program Operation Manual and other manuals supplied with the PSSE package (see PSSE Documentation). The functions and analyses available through the interface include: Power flow and related network functions One-line diagrams Optimal power flow Fault analysis Dynamic simulation Linear network analysis Transmission pricing and open access Network equivalencing Program automation
1-1
Set tap ratios to Unity Print outaged branches GENERATOR CONVERSION COMPLETED <quantity>, <bus number> ENTER OUTPUT DEVICE CODE:
Progress tab, Report tab
Activity option Program option Message sent to Progress tab Variable in message sent to Progress tab Line mode dialog request/response Activity results displayed in [Output] view PSSE activity name with hyperlink to source information Cross-reference with hyperlink to source information Short reference with hyperlink to source information Full reference with hyperlink to source information
OPEN Section 5.13.2, Figure 11-4 Creating a Power Flow Raw Data File
PSSE Program Operation Manual,
Indicates report output example clipped to fit the page PSSE Program Application Guide PSSE manual reference Indicates additional information of interest. Indicates important information. n.a. Abbreviation meaning "not applicable".
1-2
Do not try to close the copyright window that opens during PSSE-32 startup.
1-3
Working Directory
1-4
The [Program Preferences] dialog allows the specification of options when either [Spreadsheet] or [Diagram] is active.
1-5
1-6
The dialog (Figure 1-2) contains several groups of options, as defined in the following table. Table 1-1. Description of Program Preferences Options
Preference Type Output Options Enabled Options Create a new tab for every report Limit output windows to <number> lines of text Automatically save the case every <number> minutes Use the case name to Auto-Save, rather than PsseTempSave.sav Automatically number buses, lines, and equipment Auto bus and equipment numbering If you create a new case, this option automatically numbers the buses
Auto-Save option
as they are added, starting with the Initial bus number and incrementing subsequent buses as specified.
Upon changing IDs, update all open diagrams Changing an ID in [Spreadsheet] automatically changes an ID in [Diagram]. Allow single-click deletion of a bus and all its equipment A specified bus on a diagram is deleted, along with all its equipment, either by using the [Delete] key or selecting Delete from the right-click menu. Allow drag panning of the diagram The mouse pointer turns to Pan mode when the left mouse button is clicked on the diagram, held down, and dragged. If disabled, a selection box is formed around that portion of the diagram. Zoom GOUT/GEXM to extents A bus that is displayed in the diagram using the GOUT/GEXM activity will fill the entire [Diagram] area. Only Grow in-service items Diagram interactions Only those items currently in-service will be drawn during a Grow operation. Only Grow items in current bus subsystem Only those items in the current bus subsystem will be drawn during a Grow operation. Use Bus Location file to Grow items If a Bus Location file has been opened, any Grow or Auto-Draw operations will use the Bus Location file when placing buses on the diagram. Display Circuit IDs on all lines with IDs/Names Circuit IDs are displayed for every line in [Diagram] that is bound to a line in [Spreadsheet]. Allow Grow from GOUT/GEXM A diagram generated from GOUT/GEXM can run the Grow operation. This method is not the same as the auto draw grow method. When the user specifies the Grow operation for a bus, all lines connected to it and all buses connected to those lines are drawn. In other words, Grow in GOUT redraws the specified bus.
1-7
When creating a one-line diagram, the addition of network items into [Diagram] also populate [Spreadsheet] with data as you build a new network. Otherwise, the new network items display only in [Diagram].
Default GOUT/GEXM font Select a font for labels created in GOUT/GEXM diagrams. Default Bus Height Diagram interactions (continued) Specify length of the bus, in inches, when either Auto-Draw or Grow operations are in effect in a one-line diagram. Default Grow Spacing Specify distance between buses, in inches, when either Auto-Draw or Grow operations are in effect in a one-line diagram. Use Dialogs to edit Diagram Items When this option is selected, double-clicking a network item in either [Diagram] or [Network Tree] will pop up a dialog to use to edit the data, rather than jumping to the appropriate spreadsheet entry. Resize buses on one end only When selected in the Diagram view, buses will resize from one end only, not both ends. Bus data format options: Always use NUMBERS mode when reading RAW files OR Always use NAMES mode when reading RAW files OR Always prompt me when reading RAW files The option for manual specification of bus names or bus numbers whenever a Power Flow Raw Data File is read into the working case opens the [Read Power Flow Raw Data] dialog, where the For input, use bus names option may be selected when specifying the PSSE version number that created the RAW file. Always prompt to save modified files Configuration file text editor
General options
Open the directory of executable files (*.exe) to select a text editor that can be launched wherever an input configuration text file is specified. If a text file editor is specified, all the [Edit...] buttons used to edit configuration files in the various dialogs will be enabled.
1-8
1-9
Most PSSE calculation and reporting functions recognize one or more program settings. When PSS E is installed on the system, default program settings are established; see [Program Settings] dialog in Figure 1-3. Refer to PSS E Program Operation Manual, Section 3.3.3, Program Run-Time Option Settings.
1-10
See PSSE Program Operation Manual Section 17.10, Changing PSSE Program Settings for field definitions.
1-12
This activity obtains and displays execution time statistics during a work session. It initializes a timer and routes a message to the Progress tab. For example: FRI, MAY 21 2004 08:36 - TIMER INITIALIZED On subsequent runs of this activity, a summary of elapsed time, in seconds, since the previous run and cumulative times from the point at which the timers were last initialized are printed. In addition, two additional system statistics are printed, one of which indicates CPU utilization. The output is displayed in the following format: FRI, MAY 21 2004 15:21 SINCE LAST "TIME" CUMULATIVE ELAPSE XX.XXX XX.XXX USER XX.XXX XX.XXX KERNEL XX.XXX XX.XXX
The timing process is not sensitive to any interrupt control code options. At any time during a work session in PSSE, if Misc > Reset timing statistics to zero (TIME,INIT) is selected, the timers are initialized and the same initialization message is sent to the Progress tab.
1-13
Each analytical activity is available directly from pull-down menus and user-customizable toolbars. With some exceptions, the functional activities of the old interface exist in the new interface. For convenience, the traditional activity names are shown on many of the menu items. All view windows can be individually re-sized and located anywhere on the interface between the Status bar and the toolbars. The user can open and close (hide) [Tree], [Output], and [Command Line] and the Status bar by toggling the View menu items. An alternative way to close the view is to right-click within the view and select the Hide option. Right-clicking in [Tree] or [Output] brings up a menu with Allow Docking option. Toggling this option ON and OFF allows the corresponding view to float as a window or be docked to the main window. When undocked, the two views can be moved at will and resized. [Diagram] and [Spreadsheet] cannot be undocked but can be controlled using the standard Windows controls (i.e., Minimize, Maximize, Move, etc.).
1-14
Tree View
Main Menu
Toolbars
Spreadsheet View
Output Tabs
Output View
Diagram View
Status Bar
Figure 1-4. Key Elements of the Interface The default view arranges [Diagram] and [Spreadsheet] views in a stack. Data changes can be made only on the active window, that is, the top view. Click the appropriate button to make the desired view active (see Figure 1-5).
1-15
OPF Spreadsheet
Model Spreadsheet
Slider Diagram
Network Spreadsheet
Dynamics Spreadsheet
Event Spreadsheet
Figure 1-5. View Activation Buttons For convenience, Appendix A of this manual provide summaries of the toolbar options. A complete description of [Spreadsheet] may be found in Chapter 2, [Diagram] in Chapter 3, and [Tree] in Chapter 4. The Status bar displays explanatory text while you are using PSSE. For example, when moving the mouse arrow over a toolbar button the function of that button is displayed in the left portion of the Status bar. [Output] is used to display program information, dialog, errors, and warning messages. It is also used to display analysis output formatted as text reports. Standard Microsoft Windows capabilities for selecting and copying text to the clip board or saving it to an external file are supported in both views. This allows for easy transition between PSSE and external applications such as Microsoft Excel or Microsoft Word. The Copy/Paste functions relate to the type of window involved. Specifically, when you copy or cut from [Diagram], you can only paste back into [Diagram]. When working from [Spreadsheet], when you copy a cell or group of cells, you can paste the results into [Spreadsheet] or an outside application like Microsoft Excel. Further, you can copy a piece of your network from a diagram into PSSEs clipboard, you are allowed to copy a collection of cells from a Spreadsheet view into PSSE clipboard at the same time; PSSE will keep track of both copies. Afterwards, when you paste back onto the spreadsheet or an external application like Notepad, the software will know to paste the copied data from the spreadsheet. If you paste on the diagram, the software will paste the copied data from the diagram.
1-16
Many users remain faithful to the origins of PSSE when the Command Line Interface (CLI) was used for all interactive dialogs with the program. Command line input continues to be available by selecting this menu option. The resulting command line input window supports the use of legacy PSSE activity names, batch (BAT_) commands, and Python commands (see Figure 1-6). Line Mode commands entered in the Command Line Interface (CLI) are handled by a Line Mode Interpreter (LMI); Batch Commands are handled by the Batch Command interpreter, and Python Commands are passed to the embedded Python interpreter. When using the Line Mode, prompts are provided that resemble the traditional Line Mode prompts; when an activity is completed the "Activity?" prompt is presented. When an incomplete Batch Command is entered, a prompt of the form API-name: is presented. To enter batch commands or activity names, select PSSE Response from the pull-down list.
} Program Response
Command Input
An interactive session is run by typing in activity names and responding to program responses in the traditional manner. The user input must be in the Enter command field. Program responses are seen in the Progress tab. Using the command line input field will lock out access to some aspects of the program until the current command being executed is completed. The lock out aspect depends on the API being invoked. Re-selecting View > CLI Window closes [Command Line]. If the Auto-Save option has been specified in [Program Preferences], the Progress tab displays the time saved and location of the saved case. The manual PSSE Command Line Interface (CLI) Users Guide describes the operation of PSSE using its command line interface.
1-17
(a)
(b)
Figure 1-7. New and Build New Case Dialogs The system stores the heading lines as comments if the case is exported. They are used to document the case. A new working case can be created merely by typing data elements directly into a blank spreadsheet. This method would typically be limited to only small cases or to establish a small network model into which significantly more data could be pasted into or imported.
1-18
Section 10.1 Section 3.19 Section 10.4 Section 6.4, Section 6.3.2 Section 20.6 Section 20.1 Section 20.1.1 Section 20.3 Section 3.6.8 Section 10.5 Section 19.7 Section 10.6 Section 10.3 Section 3.19
UCTE Data Exchange Format Application Guide and Manual
1-19
During operation of PSSE, the last used options specified in each dialog are saved. However, the user may want to go back to the default dialog options but does not remember what they are. This function restores all options specified in the dialog boxes to their respective defaults.
This function closes the application. If the default option Always prompt to save modified files is enabled in [Program Preferences], you will see a prompt requiring confirmation to save changes to the working case. If this option is disabled, all files are closed without saving, regardless of their status, modified or un-modified. This setting is preserved between from the current work session to the next.
1-20
1-21
1-22
Chapter 2
Spreadsheet View
2.1 Introduction
All network data components (e.g., buses, lines, loads) are represented on worksheet-style tabs in [Spreadsheet] view. At program startup [Spreadsheet] is displayed only after a raw data or saved case file is opened. Pencil Icon (Working Case Not Updated) Column Right-Click Menu
Tab Scroll
2-1
Spreadsheets are constructed to display data in arrangements that are convenient to review and modify for specific PSSE activities. Although many of the column headings are abbreviated for easier scanning, the following lists are unabbreviated. [Network Spreadsheet] is the default view for the interface and remains open once it is populated. Tabs are provided to review and modify data for the following network component types:
Bus Fixed Shunt 2-Winding Transformer 2-Terminal dc Line Inter-area Transfer Mutual Coupling Plant Switched Shunt 3-Winding Transformer VSC dc Line Owner Machine Branch Impedance Table Multi-terminal dc Line Zone Load Breaker/Switch FACTS Device Area Multi-section Line
For more information, refer to Section 2.3, Network Spreadsheet. [OPF Spreadsheet] contains tabs provided to review and modify data in the following data categories:
Bus Voltage Attribute Adjustable Bus Shunt Adjustable Branch Reactance Branch Flow Adjustable Bus Load Adjustable Load Table Generator Dispatch / Subsystem Generation Reactive Capability Generation Reserve Bus Voltage Attribute / Subsystem Adjustable Bus Shunt / Subsystem Adjustable Branch Reactance / Subsystem Branch Flow / Subsystem Adjustable Bus Load / Subsystem Generator Dispatch Dispatch Table Generation Reactive Capability / Subsystem Generation Reserve / Subsystem
For more information, refer to Section 2.4, OPF Spreadsheet. [Dynamics Spreadsheet] is used to add, remove, edit and change the status of models attached to network elements, with tabs provided for the following model types:
Machine: Generator Exciter Governor Stabilizer Minimum Exciter Maximum Exciter Compensating Turbine Load Controller Wind Machine: Generator Electrical Mechanical Pitch Aerodynamic Gust Auxiliary Control 2-Terminal dc Line VSC dc Line N-Terminal dc Line FACTS Device Line Relay Switched Shunt Load - Bus Load - Owner Load - Zone Load - Area Load - All
2-2
The data tab contains cells to modify CONs, VARs, ICONs, and Channels. For more information, refer to Section 2.5, Dynamics Spreadsheet . [Event Spreadsheet] provides a summary of faults established for an event study (see Chapter 25) and the means to enable/disable or synchronize events for a particular dynamic simulation. For more information, refer to Section 2.7, Event Spreadsheet. .
2-3
Figure 2-2. Spreadsheet Column Right-Click Menu Bus numbers and other identifiers are not copied as this would result in duplicate data items in the network. Instead, the next available unused identifier is placed in the field. If the copied area exceeds the number of rows available, PSSE will automatically create the extra network elements required (and generate appropriate bus numbers). The column heading right-click menu (Figure 2-2) provides access to the [Find] and [Replace] dialogs (also available through the Edit Menu). Sorting and filtering capabilities are provided to increase usability, especially with large systems. Any data edits performed within a filtered spreadsheet will automatically be reflected in the original unfiltered sheet. This allows the use of a reduced data set on which to perform edits. Spreadsheet appearance and data entry precision can also be customized using this menu. Highlight the entire column to use these features. Set column style opens the [Cells] dialog (Figure 2-3), with tabs to change the font, color, and border of the cells in the highlighted column. Set column precision opens an option list that permits data precision up to 6 decimal places.
2-4
Figure 2-3. Cells Dialog Color coding as a data visibility option is also available for those columns that are grayed out, that is, not available for edit on a particular worksheet. However, only the appearance of the column changes; the data record can be edited only from the appropriate worksheet (for example, Bus Number from the Bus tab; Pgen from the Machine tab). The toolbar options to zoom in/out and return to 100% are active in [Spreadsheet], although magnification about 150% becomes illegible unless the row height is also increased. The right-click menu for bus data records also contains the option Create bus display (GOUT/GEXM). Refer to Section 3.15, Creating a Bus Display for details. File Menu options include options to set up printing formats for the spreadsheet data. See Section 2.2.5, Print Setup for details. In order to access File Menu options, [Spreadsheet] must be the active view. Click in any cell to make it active if the desired option does not appear in the menu.
2-5
The [Header / Footer] dialog (Figure 2-4) provides settings for header and footer spacing, the alignment, page numbering and the style, size and other font characteristics. If the Save settings to profile option is enabled, then the saved profile will be activated at the next PSSE work session.
2-6
The [Page Setup] dialog (Figure 2-5) provides settings for margins and grid lines. If the Save settings to profile option is enabled, then the saved profile will be activated at the next PSSE work session.
2-7
Figure 2-6. Print Setup Dialog The File > Print Preview action provides view options of each page, using the [Next Page] button, and [Zoom] options from full page view to 100%. To return to [Spreadsheet] without printing, press the keyboard [Esc] key.
2-8
Figure 2-7. Network Spreadsheet View, Bus Tab Network elements may be added, modified, or deleted in the appropriate worksheet. If a subsystem selector has been activated to reduce the amount of network data presented at any one time, readonly fields are colored light gray to distinguish them from editable fields. See Section 2.3.2, Creating a Bus Subsystem and Section 2.3.3, Using the Subsystem Menu.
2-9
Most data fields may be edited directly by clicking in the cell and entering in the desired value. Editable area, owner, and zone cells have [Area Selection], [Owner Selection], and [Zone Selection] dialogs available by double-clicking in the cell. Data fields that contain check boxes (for example, in-service, metered, and auto-adjust options) are considered to be enabled when checked and disabled when unchecked. Some data cells require specification from a list of valid entries (for example, I/O code for a winding, impedance, or admittance). Clicking in the cell displays a pull-down list from which one value may be specified.
a.
b.
2-10
A bus subsystem can also be created using the [Bus Subsystem Selector] dialog (Figure 2-9). Using this method, a subsystem can be built using filters by area, owner, zone, base kV, or bus numbers. Each category is available on a separate tab. For Areas, Owners, Zones, and Buses use the appropriate lists to specify the subsystem. Click [Reset] to return all entries in the Selected list to the Unselected list. The Buses tab provides a [Filter] button that opens the [Filter Bus Subsystem Selection] dialog (Figure 2-10), an additional mechanism to exclude buses from the selection process in very large systems.
2-11
Figure 2-10. Filter Bus Subsystem Selection Dialog After specifying the subsystem, click [Apply]. The tab with a specified subsystem will be marked with an asterisk (for example Buses * ) until the selected component is returned to the unselected list. Click [Memorize] to preserve a specific subsystem for later recollection. The [Save As] dialog requires entering a filename for the Bus Subsystem file (*.sbs). Click [Recall] to open a saved Bus Subsystem file (*.sbs). Click [OK] to close the dialog and refresh [Spreadsheet]. Only data corresponding to the subsystem is displayed, until a new subsystem selection is made. To return the entire working case to [Spreadsheet], select Subsystem > Bus and select the All buses check box from [Bus Subsystem Selector] or click the ALL BUS icon.
2-12
This function toggles between two subsystems. Under normal operation, only one subsystem is created at a time. However, a second subsystem will be created when, in [Diagram], information is requested for an element that is not in the current subsystem. The creation of the second subsystem allows the first subsystem to be preserved.
2-13
Change numeric values by overwriting the value in the cell. Non-numeric specifications are changed using a pull-down list, available by clicking to the right of the cell contents. Table 2-1 summarizes the choices available from the pull-down lists. Wherever appropriate, these lists provide the same options for each worksheet in which they occur. Table 2-1. OPF Non-Numeric Attribute Options
OPF Spreadsheet Data Record Bus Voltage Bus Voltage / Subsystem Attribute Adjust Limits Fix Open Options No change
2-14
2-15
[Dynamics Spreadsheet] is synchronized with the bus subsystem selector (see Figure 2-9) so that a subset of the data can be viewed during a work session. It can be minimized, but you cannot close it unless you close the working case.
Figure 2-12. Dynamics Spreadsheet View Model types may be added, modified, or deleted using this spreadsheet. Certain network elements, such as machines, must have Dynamics models defined. For these elements, the spreadsheets will contain an entry for every corresponding network element. Other elements dont require a Dynamics model, so these spreadsheets will be empty if no Dynamics models were defined for them in either the Snapshot or DYRE file. Models can be added for these elements either by double-clicking an editable cell to open a selector dialog or just entering the values by typing them into the spreadsheet. If you create a new entry for a network element in one of the spreadsheets without specifying any Dynamics models, the message No models specified pops up. Dynamics models must then be defined or the entry removed using the Edit > Undo command. Use the In Service checkbox to place a model in-service or out-of-service. Model changes are initiated from the right-click menu (Figure 2-13) available in the model type cells.
2-16
Figure 2-13. Dynamics Spreadsheet Menu Selecting Edit Model from the menu opens the [Edit Model Parameters] dialog (Figure 2-14) where values of the parameters (CONs/ICONs/VARs) associated with that particular instance of the model at that particular network element can be changed.
2-17
Selecting Add/Replace Model from the menu opens the [Model Selection] dialog (Figure 2-15) which provides a list of available models appropriate for the type of network element being modified. When adding a model, the default status is out-of-service. Use the checkbox to place the new model in-service.
Figure 2-15. Model Selection Dialog, Generator Models Selecting Remove Model from the menu deletes the model from the simulation; the in-service flag is ignored until a model is replaced.
2-18
2-19
[Models Spreadsheet] (Figure 2-17) is used to modify the CONs and ICONs associated with the individual Dynamics models attached to network elements. Using [Models Spreadsheet], all the CONs and ICONS associated with all instances of a particular model in the current network can be examined at once, providing a way to make quick data value range checks or modifications.
Figure 2-17. Models Spreadsheet The columns containing a particular CON, ICON, or VAR can be sorted by double-clicking the column header, just as in [Network Spreadsheet]. Copy/Paste operations work the same as described for [Network Spreadsheet].
2-20
Individual faults/events may be de-activated from a particular simulation without removing the fault from the event study. The event name may be edited for clarity, as the default names are created in numeric sequence, which may not correspond to the synchronization of the study. Timing of the event within the simulation period may also be edited from this spreadsheet.
2-21
This activity exports all data from an open spreadsheet to a tab-delimited file. The file selection window in the [Save As] dialog lists only Text Files (*.txt). Specify the filename; this can be a new file or a previously-built file to be over-written.
This action returns a PSSE operation to its state previous to the run of an automation file (see Section 23.3, Executing Automation Files). It is necessary when adding a new record to any of the spreadsheets and the application generates an error message about missing information. At certain points, this can lead to application lockup. The Add operation cannot continue until the missing data is provided and the missing data cannot be provided because the application keeps notifying the user of the problem. At this point, Edit > Undo Record will reset the application back to the state before the Add operation was begun. The missing data can then be added in other spreadsheets and the item added again. Once the data has been entered, however, the Undo Record operation will have no effect.
2-22
Chapter 3
Diagram View
3.1 Introduction
[Diagram] view (Figure 3-1) is used to create and modify one-line diagrams and to display a variety of results, such as: Power flow results (Section 3.8) Network impedances (Section 3.9) Graphical differences between power flow cases (Section 3.10) Fault analysis results (Section 3.11) IEC fault calculations results (Section 3.12) Reliability analysis results (Section 3.13) Dynamic simulation results (Section 3.14)
To open [Diagram], open an existing diagram (File > Open > Slider Binary file (*.sld)), or begin a new diagram (File > New > Diagram). As you add new elements to a diagram, [Network Spreadsheet] (Chapter 2) and [Network Tree] (Chapter 4) are automatically updated to reflect the addition. To move from [Diagram] to [Network Spreadsheet], double-click the desired diagram component. [Network Spreadsheet] opens to the specified data tab and highlights the row of data for that component.
3-1
3-2
The [Diagram Properties] dialog (Figure 3-2), available only when [Diagram] is the active view, supports user-configurable settings, such as units, background colors, grid spacing, and zoom / pan thresholds.
Figure 3-2. Diagram Properties Dialog Labels: Select from a variety of font styles, sizes and colors for labels. Options for hiding or showing all labels and hiding results labels are also available. Click [ ] to open the [Color] dialog (Figure 3-3) or click [Font] to open the [Font] dialog (Figure 3-4) to change label color or font.
3-3
3-4
Grid: An underlying grid pattern may be made visible. Line style and width, grid spacing, and snap distance, may be specified. For very dense diagrams the snap distance must be small enough to ensure that items snap to the desired grid point instead of one further away. General Colors: Defines background, grid, and port colors. Click [ ] to open the [Color] dialog (Figure 3-3). The port symbol is a small circle that appears at a location where a line or equipment connects to a bus. Ports appear as connection points when selecting lines or equipment and move to the new bus location when changes are made from [Diagram]. Network Items Colors: Defines colors for bound and unbound diagram items and power flow direction. Click [ ] to open the [Color] dialog (Figure 3-3). All network items in [Diagram] that represent real network data are drawn in the bound color Section 3.6.4), unless the color has been over-ridden by range checking coloration (Figure 3-46). All network items added to a diagram that do not represent data in the network are drawn in the unbound color. The P flow arrow and the Q flow arrow display animated flow directions for real and reactive power for power flow results (Figure 3-46). Precision: Defines the number of decimal places to be used in representing power flow and short circuit results on a diagram. Zoom/Pan: Enter values for zoom factors directly in the fields provided. In addition, it is possible to hide some diagram items when the zoom factor is small and the diagram becomes crowded, including the handles that appear at each end of a bus when it is selected. These values set limits. The diagram can be expanded, reduced and panned using the Zoom Toolbar buttons. Computers equipped with a mouse-wheel can pan vertically using just the mouse-wheel. Holding down the [Shift] key while moving the mouse-wheel will pan horizontally. Holding down the [Ctrl] key while moving the mouse-wheel will zoom. Keyboard arrow keys may also be used to pan the image. Image File Directory: Click [ ] to open the dialog specifying a default path for commonly used images. These images may be imported to the background layer of [Diagram].
3-5
Figure 3-5. Select Directory for Image Files Dialog Printing: Three options are available for printing a diagram: As seen on the screen: WYSIWYG (What you see is what you get.) prints only the visible portion of the one-line diagram. If you have zoomed in to see greater detail, this might be only a portion of a bus. Verify the desired print area by selecting File > Print Preview. Fit the whole diagram to page: The entire one-line diagram is printed on one page, independent of whether or not the entire diagram is shown in [Diagram]. Multi-page: The entire diagram is printed on multiple pages, independent of whether or not the entire diagram is visible in [Diagram]. In addition, a muiltiple-page diagram may be scaled. This is useful when the one-line diagram is large.
The user must specify loading chart placement for 2-winding transformers from the following options: High current loading side Low current loading side Both sides
Other diagram options may be enabled using checkboxes. If Display Tooltips is enabled, moving the mouse cursor over a diagram item opens a pop-up note that provides basic information, such as bus number, name, and base kV.
3-6
Diagram View Creating a New Power Flow Case using Diagram View
3-7
Diagram View Creating a New Power Flow Case using Diagram View
Vertical Bus
Horizontal Bus To add buses to the diagram, and consequently the database, select a Bus toolbar button (vertical or horizontal) in the Diagram toolbar. Click [Diagram] in those locations where the buses are to be placed. They can be moved and otherwise adjusted later. As buses are added to the diagram, they will also be added to the spreadsheet with default values; in other words, they are bound to the spreadsheet. Default values can be subsequently modified by editing in [Spreadsheet].
Buses are added to Spreadsheet View as they are added to the Diagram View Bus Toolbar Button
Figure 3-7. Adding Buses to the Database Using the Diagram View
3-8
Diagram View Creating a New Power Flow Case using Diagram View
Branch
Breaker
Switch
Load
Generator
Switched Shunt
Fixed Shunt
FACTS Device
2-Winding Transformer
3-Winding Transformer
2-Terminal dc Line
VSC dc Line
With the buses roughly positioned, select the Branch button and drag the mouse between two buses to represent branch connections. Select the Breaker button or the Switch button and drag the mouse to a branch to represent these connections. Select the Load button and drag the mouse from a bus to an adjacent empty area. Select the Generator button and drag the mouse between two buses. Edit the data in [Spreadsheet] to change default values. Figure 3-8 summarizes an example. As each element is added, a summary of the case building activity is displayed in the Progress tab. See Section 3.19, Closing the Diagram View for options to save the diagram.
3-9
Diagram View Creating a New Power Flow Case using Diagram View
Adding a Branch
Adding a Generator
Adding a Load
3-10
From the [Open] file selector window, select Slider Binary File (*.sld). Highlight the desired file and click [Open]. The resulting diagram will be displayed in a new diagram window.
From the [New] dialog, select the Diagram option to create a blank [Diagram]. Then select File > Import > DRAW file. A list of available *.drw files will be provided. Highlight the desired file and click [Open]. DRAW coordinate data files cannot be opened using File > Open from the Main Menu. The open DRAW file can be saved as a Slider Binary file (*.sld). Select File > Save As and rename the file as a slider file. Although existing PSSE DRAW files can be imported, diagrams can be saved only in the slider format (*.sld). The new diagrams are not backward compatible with the PSSE DRAW/DRED activities used to display and edit one-line diagrams in earlier versions of PSSE.
3-11
Image files may be imported into a diagram if they are formatted as *.bmp, *.jpg, *.gif, or *.png files. From the [Import Image File] selector window, select the desired file type. Highlight the desired file and click [Open]. The image will be displayed in the active diagram layer. To assign image attributes, right-click the image and select Image Properties. The [Image Properties] dialog permits layer reassignment (see Section 3.17.3, Diagram Layers), scaling, and options to select and move the image in the diagram as if it were a network element. However, there is no network data associated with the image.
3-12
Diagram templates can be used to build a library of common network configurations to be used over and over when creating new network elements. The diagram template function was initially created for use with the Substation Reliability Assessment (SRA) option. As engineers add detailed bus/breaker/switch substation configurations to their networks for evaluation, the same configurations repeat over and over. The diagram template allows you to create the basic substation configuration once and then use it to reproduce the substation repeatedly in the network. Diagram templates can be created using buses, branches, switches, breakers, loads etc. The diagram template is created and saved without network data associated, only the topology of the network elements is maintained (see Figure 3-10 for an example). When a diagram template is inserted in a slider diagram, the network topology is created in the network and default data is assigned to each new element.
Figure 3-10. Diagram Template, Double Bus and Single Breaker, 4 Circuits
3-13
3-14
3-15
The remaining right-click menu functions are sensitive to the bind option. If the bind option has been enabled for Cut and Copy functions, both the graphic representation and the corresponding model information are available from the diagram clipboard. If it has not been enabled, only the graphic representation is available from the diagram clipboard. If the bind option has been enabled for the Paste function, and the copied area exceeds the number of existing elements, PSSE will automatically create the extra network elements required (and generate appropriate bus numbers). If the bind option has been enabled for the Delete function, all network elements removed from the diagram are also removed from the working case. Unless the edited diagram has been saved, Edit > Undo will reverse the last 30 actions, undoing both [Diagram] and network changes. To copy a diagram from PSSE to another application, such as Microsoft Word, the system clipboard is used. Select Edit > Copy to clipboard. This action copies everything visible in [Diagram] to the clipboard; the user cannot select specific elements. To paste the clipboard contents to another application, use the paste function in that application. Note that the system copy is a screen capture of the [Diagram] view; and if components have been highlighted, the handles will be visible in the pasted copy.
3-16
3-17
Figure 3-12. Select Bus Dialog Display: Diagrams may be comprised of multiple layers, where each layer has an associated display list, a list of graphical objects. Individual network items are drawn in display-list order. If it is desirable to have a particular item drawn after or before another, for example, where two diagram items occupy the same general area in [Diagram] and one needs to be drawn over the other, layers become necessary. For each of the following functions, a network element must be highlighted. Selecting Display > Bring to Front moves the specified item to the end of the display list. This object is drawn last, on top of the other graphical objects in the same layer. Selecting Display > Send to Back moves the selected item to the beginning of the display list. This object is drawn first, and other items in the same layer should be drawn on top of this network item. Selecting Display > Center moves the specified item to the center of [Diagram]. Selecting Display > Assign to Layer opens the [Select Layer] dialog to move the selected item to a predefined layer (see Figure 3-76). Grouping: Diagram items may be grouped into logical units. These units can then be modified as a single entity. Grouping items together is particularly helpful when moving a collection of diagram elements. A group cannot consist of only one item. Diagram items can belong to only one group at a time. If you attempt to reassign an item to another group, it is removed from the existing group before being added to the new group. Define a block to be grouped by dragging the mouse on a portion of the diagram. Or define the group one item at a time by using [Ctrl]+ left-mouse-click to selectively add items to the group. Select Grouping > Group to build a group out of all the specified diagram items. To return a group to its individual items, highlight the group by clicking any item. Then select
Grouping > Ungroup.
The system manages annotations (labels) associated with a given device as if it were grouped with the device. If the device is deleted, the related annotation is also deleted. If the selected device is moved, the related annotation is also moved. Therefore, adding a device to a larger group, in effect, adds all the related annotation to the larger group as well. This grouping behavior automatically moves annotations when the device is moved (called autopositioning), but can be disabled
3-18
by selecting Item Properties > Auto Position. When autopositioning is disabled, the annotation must be explicitly selected to be added to the group during the grouping operation. Labels: The user can show or hide diagram labels (also called annotations). In order to be activated, the Labels > Toggle label selectability option is used to open the following dialog.
After selectability is activated, use the toggle button in the toolbar to show/hide the labels. Manage Layers: The [Layers] dialog (Figure 3-74) provides the means to create layers for a specified diagram. Each layer has its own Visibility options, as well as an option to turn selectability on and off. See Section 3.17.3, Diagram Layers. Manage Views: The [Saved Views] dialog (Figure 3-14) provides provides the means to create and retrieve a variety of one-line diagram presentations. These may be desirable for re-displaying unique views of the data, for example, results at different zoom levels from different parts of the network. If specific views are needed on a regular basis, then those views can be stored for rapid retrieval.
New Delete Move Up Move Down
Figure 3-14. Saved Views Dialog Click the new view icon, enter a name for the current view, and click [Save]. The title of the view appears in the dialog list. Double-click the title to edit the view. Highlight the desired view and click [Restore] to reposition the diagram to the saved view. Highlight the desired view and use the up and down arrows to re-order the list. Any view except Default may be deleted.
3-19
Network Data: Highlight the desired network item and select this function to activate [Network Spreadsheet], which displays the appropriate data tab and highlights the appropriate row. The data can then be examined and manipulated as desired. Only one network item at a time may be selected. See also Section 3.6.1, Using Data Records. Create bus subsystem: Define a block to be defined by dragging the mouse on a portion of the diagram and select this function to define a bus subsystem. Both [Spreadsheet] and [Network Tree] will be updated to reflect the new subsystem sselection. Diagram Annotation: This function opens the [Powerflow Data Annotation] dialog (Figure 3-44) where diagram annotations (that is, branch, bus, equipment labels and diagram title) and diagram range checking options can be set. These are described in Section 3.8.1 and Section 3.8.2. Item Properties > Auto Position: If no network item is specified, this function opens the [Enable Auto Position] dialog, where the auto-position mode for the entire diagram may be set. If only one equipment item or annotation is specified (i.e. machine, load, capacitor), then the Auto Position option can be toggled ON or OFF for the selected element. If auto-positioning is enabled, the equipment or annotation connected to a bus will orient itself perpendicular to the bus. Toggling this property OFF allows the diagram item to be positioned in any orientation (see Figure 3-15).
Figure 3-15. Impact of Auto-Positioning Item Properties > Auto Relink: If no bus is specified, this function opens the [Enable Auto Relink] dialog, where the auto-relink mode for all buses in the diagram may be set. If only one busbar/bus node is specified, then the Auto Relink option can be toggled ON or OFF for the selected bus. If auto-relinking is enabled, moving or re-sizing a busbar causes the attached branches and transformers to re-attach themselves for a perceived optimal representation. Toggling this property OFF allows the busbar to be moved or re-sized without affecting the attachment of branches and transformers. Item Properties > Auto Rotate: When a non-bus item is specified, this function opens the [Enable Auto Rotate] dialog, which allows equipment connected to the bus to rotate when the bus is rotated. Toggling this property OFF keeps the original position of the equipment when the bus is rotated. Item Properties > Font: When a label (annotation) is specified, this function opens the [Font] dialog (Figure 3-4) from which a new text font, style, and point size for the selected item and its result labels can be applied. Item Properties > Line Style / Color: When a line is specified, this function opens the [Line Style] dialog (Figure 3-16) from which the line type (solid or dotted), width, and color may be changed. This function may also be used to change the color of annotations or primitive shapes. Primitive shapes include straight lines, arcs, circles, polygons, etc., available on the Diagram Toolbar with the other network diagram elements.
3-20
Figure 3-16. Line Style Dialog Item Properties > Visible: When a network item is specified, it may be made invisible using this function. The item is still available, as its handles appear when the location of the item is clicked. Thus, an invisible network item may be made visible using this function. Item Properties > Unbind: When one or more diagram elements are specified, they may be disassociated from the corresponding network item, overriding the previously enabled binding. In order to re-establish binding, the network model item in [Network Tree] and the diagram element must be reselected. Then select the Bind option from the [Network Tree] right-click menu. Item Properties > Location: Certain diagram elements allow the specification of GIS coordinates. This is useful for providing locations for network elements for use with Google Maps. Item Properties > Map String: This is used to edit the mapping string used to associate a diagram item with a specific network element. Most users will have no need to alter this field, but certain Python APIs can be used to set and query these map strings and perform operations based on results. Item Annotation: When a network item is specified, an item-specific dialog provides the means to change the way its annotation is displayed. For example, the [Bus Annotation Properties] dialog (Figure 3-29) is displayed when the specified item is a bus. You may choose to apply the changes to the specified bus or to all buses. See also Section 3.8.1, Power Flow Annotation, Section 3.9.1, Impedance Annotation, Section 3.10.1, Comparison Annotation, Section 3.11.1, Fault Analysis Data Annotation, Section 3.12.1, IEC Fault Analysis Annotation, Section 3.13.1, Reliability Annotation, and Section 3.14.1, Dynamics Annotation. The items at the bottom of the [Diagram] right-click menu are customized to the element(s) selected. Figure 3-17 shows the difference between specifying one or two buses and lines. Other functions are available when another type of equipment is selected (i.e., load, machine, etc). This sections provides a description of all possible functions.
3-21
Figure 3-17. Customized Right-Click Menu Toggle bus symbol: This function toggles the specified bus between the busbar and busnode representations (see Figure 3-18).
Figure 3-18. Alternative Bus Symbols Grow N Levels: The [Specify Grow Levels] dialog specifies a method for drawing elements connected to the bus (see Section 3.7). Split bus: The [Split Bus] dialog requires a new bus number, name and base kV for the additional bus. Click [OK] to split the bus, preserving the existing one and adding the new one to the diagram. Equipment and lines can then be dragged to the new bus. See also Section 7.4, Splitting Buses. Join buses: This function is available when two buses have been specified. The [Join Buses] dialog requires specification of an option to handle Line shunts of deleted in-service branches. Click [OK] to join the two buses into a single retained bus. See also Section 7.3, Joining Buses. Switch: This function changes the status of a network component. Visual representation of out-ofservice equipment is specified using [Powerflow Data Annotation] (see Section 3.8.2, Range Checking). A summary of the change is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 3-19). When using this function to disconnnect a bus, its type code is set to 4 and all ac branches, dc lines, and series FACTS devices connected to the bus are represented as out-of-service. Toggle load symbol: This function toggles the specified load symbol size.
3-22
Summary of Changes
Figure 3-19. Example of Switch Function to Out-of-Service For bus connected capacitors and reactors the Switch option is not available. To switch the status of capacitors and reactors, double-click the network item (or right-click and select Network data) to edit the status field of the corresponding data record in [Spreadsheet]. Combine/Split Machines: This function is available when a single bus with at least one connected machine is selected. When performed, it combines multiple machine diagram items at the bus into a single summing machine symbol, where results are summed for total generation at the bus. A summing machine symbol has no machine ID in the center of the symbol, whereas a machine diagram item representing a single machine has a machine ID in the center of the symbol. If only a summing machine symbol exists on the bus, selecting the bus and the Combine/Split Machines function will remove the summing machine symbol and replace it with one or more machine diagram items representing the individual machines at the bus. Combine/Split Loads: This function is available when a single bus with at least one load is selected. Its action is comparable to Combine/Split Machines, affecting the bus load. Combine/Split Fixed Shunts: This function is available when a single bus with at least one fixed shunt is selected. Its action is comparable to Combine/Split Machines, affecting the fixed shunt.
3-23
Collapse buses towards high voltage bus: This function is available when two buses are selected. It is used to visually change the layout in [Diagram], and has no effect on the actual network. When performed, all components on the lower voltage bus appear to be connected to the high voltage bus, and the lower voltage bus is removed, as well as any connections between the two buses. Only [Diagram] is affected; these components are not removed from the actual network. If an analysis is performed, all components of the two buses are included in the calculations. Collapse buses towards low voltage bus: This function is available when two buses are selected. It is used to visually change the layout in [Diagram], and has no effect on the actual network. When performed, all components on the lower voltage bus appear to be connected to the low voltage bus, and the higher voltage bus is removed, as well as any connections between the two buses. Only [Diagram] is affected; these components are not removed from the actual network. If an analysis is performed, all components of the two buses are included in the calculations. Tap Line: This function is available when a line is selected. The [Tap Line] dialog requires specification of the tap location and identification of the new bus. Any nontransformer branch may be tapped. Click [OK] to tap the line. See also Section 7.5, Tapping a Line. Insert Breaker: This function is available when a line is selected. This is used to insert a dummy bus node and a specially identified zero impedance line that is used to model a breaker in substation reliability analysis. The [Insert a Breaker] dialog (Figure 3-20) requires specification of the dummy bus created to build the breaker. Click [OK] to add the breaker.
3-24
Insert Switch: This function is available when a line is selected. This is used to insert a dummy bus node and a specially identified zero impedance line that is used to model a switch in substation reliability analysis. The [Insert a Switch] dialog (Figure 3-21) requires specification of the dummy bus created to build the switch.
The Renumber Buses in Diagram option is available only when working in [Diagram]. It opens the [Bus number translation file] selection window for the required Bus Number Translation file (*.trn). The creation of this file is described in Section 7.16, Renumbering Buses. The file contains records of old bus numbers and the corresponding new numbers.
Loading a Bus Location Data File (*.loc) from the [Open] dialog allows the bus locations in the diagram to be specified from the same Cartesian or GIS coordinates across repeated analyses or different working case subsystem configurations. File data is used to position any buses drawn or Grown for which an entry exists in the file. Those buses in the working case that are not defined in the file are assigned default locations in the diagram. The same file is used to reposition buses in an existing diagram; select Diagram > Update bus locations after the file is loaded. If no Bus Location file has been loaded, this function is disabled. Buses may be specified for repositioning. If buses are selected, only those buses will be evaluated for update. If no buses are selected, all buses in the diagram will be evaluated for update.
3-25
Bus Location Data File Contents Bus positions on a diagram may be specified in a Bus Location file that can be accessed whenever a bus is created. These positions can be specified as x/y coordinates or as GIS coordinates in an hour, minutes, seconds format. The format of the file is as follows: CARTESIAN | GEOPHYSICAL The first record in the file describes the format of all bus position records. CARTESIAN specifies that bus positions are provided as x/y locations on the diagram. GEOPHYSICAL specifies that bus positions are provided in GIS form as two pairs of hour, minute, seconds inputs. The next N lines specify the bus positions. The Bus Location file does not require an entry for every bus in the case. If a bus position record is not found in the file when positioning a bus on the diagram, default bus positioning is used. The format of a CARTESIAN bus position record is as follows: BusId, X location, Y location, Rotation, Length where: BusId X location Y location Rotation Length Either a bus number or a quoted extended bus name. The bus X location, in inches, on the diagram. The bus Y location, in inches, on the diagram. The optional bus rotation, in degrees. The optional length of the busbar, in inches.
The format of a GEOPHYSICAL bus position record is as follows: BusId, X location, Y location, Rotation, Length where: BusId X location Y location Rotation Length Either a bus number or a quoted extended bus name. The bus X location, in degrees latitude (see format, below). The bus Y location, in degrees longitude (see format, below). The optional bus rotation, in degrees. The optional length of the busbar, in inches.
Degrees are specified as a set of 1 to 3 real numbers (degrees, minutes, seconds) followed by a direction (E, W, N, S) (the direction can be omitted if all three numbers are specified). Positive values are interpreted as E or N, negative values as W or S. The degree parts can be separated by spaces, commas, apostrophes, or by the specific unit markers for degree, minutes, or seconds (in which case they must be used in order).
3-26
For example, the following all represent the same value: 793036W -79 -30 -36 79.51W -79.51,,, The Bus Location file can also contain location entries for branches and two winding transformers found in the network. Branch and two winding transformers records are indicated by the BRANCH record appearing in the file. BRANCH The format of a CARTESIAN branch position record is as follows: FromBusId ToBusId CircuitId X From loc Y From loc X KP1 loc Y KP1 loc X KPn loc Y KPn loc X To loc Y To loc Either a bus number or a quoted extended bus name of the from bus. Either a bus number or a quoted extended bus name of the to bus. Circuit Id of branch. The from bus X location, in inches, on the diagram. The from bus Y location, in inches, on the diagram. The first knee point X location, in inches, on the diagram. The first knee point Y location, in inches, on the diagram. The nth knee point X location, in inches, on the diagram. The nth knee point Y location, in inches, on the diagram. The to bus X location, in inches, on the diagram. The to bus Y location, in inches, on the diagram.
The format of a GEOPHYSICAL branch position record is as follows: FromBusId ToBusId CircuitId X From loc Y From loc X KP1 loc Y KP1 loc X KPn loc Y KPn loc X To loc Y To loc Either a bus number or a quoted extended bus name of the from bus. Either a bus number or a quoted extended bus name of the to bus. Circuit Id of branch. The from bus X location, in degrees latitude (see format, above). The from bus Y location, in degrees latitude (see format, above). The first knee point X location, in degrees latitude (see format, above). The first knee point Y location, in degrees latitude (see format, above). The nth knee point X location, in degrees latitude (see format, above). The nth knee point Y location, in degrees latitude (see format, above). The to bus X location, in degrees latitude (see format, above). The to bus Y location, in degrees latitude (see format, above).
If there are no kneepoints associated with the branch, there will be no X & Y KPn entries in the record.
3-27
The format of a CARTESIAN two winding transformer position record is as follows: FromBusId ToBusId CircuitId X From loc Y From loc X Sym loc Y Sym loc X KP1 loc Y KP1 loc X KPn loc Y KPn loc X To loc Y To loc Either a bus number or a quoted extended bus name of the from bus. Either a bus number or a quoted extended bus name of the to bus. Circuit Id of two winding transformer. The from bus X location, in inches, on the diagram. The from bus Y location, in inches, on the diagram. The two winding transformer symbol X location, in inches, on the diagram. The two winding transformer symbol Y location, in inches, on the diagram. The first knee point X location, in inches, on the diagram. The first knee point Y location, in inches, on the diagram. The nth knee point X location, in inches, on the diagram. The nth knee point Y location, in inches, on the diagram. The to bus X location, in inches, on the diagram. The to bus Y location, in inches, on the diagram.
The format of a GEOPHYSICAL two winding transformer position record is as follows: FromBusId ToBusId CircuitId X From loc Y From loc X Sym loc Y Sym loc X KP1 loc Y KP1 loc X KPn loc Y KPn loc X To loc Y To loc Either a bus number or a quoted extended bus name of the from bus. Either a bus number or a quoted extended bus name of the to bus. Circuit Id of two winding transformer. The from bus X location, in degrees latitude (see format, above). The from bus Y location, in degrees latitude (see format, above). The two winding transformer symbol X location, in degrees latitude (see format, above). The two winding transformer symbol Y location, in degrees latitude (see format, above). The first knee point X location, in degrees latitude (see format, above). The first knee point Y location, in degrees latitude (see format, above). The nth knee point X location, in degrees latitude (see format, above). The nth knee point Y location, in degrees latitude (see format, above). The to bus X location, in degrees latitude (see format, above). The to bus Y location, in degrees latitude (see format, above).
If there are no kneepoints associated with the two winding transformer, there will be no X & Y KPn entries in the record.
3-28
Figure 3-22. Moving and Resizing Buses To move existing equipment and lines: 1.Click the diagram component you wish to move; a bus end connection is illuminated with a circle (Figure 3-23a). 2.Drag the end to the new attachment point. Valid attachment points will be illuminated with circles as the mouse passes over them (Figure 3-23b). 3.When the end illuminates the desired attachment point, release the mouse to connect the diagram component (Figure 3-23c). The capacitor symbol direction from the bus can be controlled. Drag the connection circle to the desired edge of the busbar; the crosshairs in the circle will guide you.
3-29
(a) Selecting
Figure 3-23. Moving Equipment Not only can equipment and lines be moved to another location on a bus but they can also be moved to another bus, using the same technique. If Bind Items is selected, (see Section 3.6.4) moving equipment and lines to another bus in [Diagram] will also move the equipment and lines in [Network Tree]. The change will also be reflected in [Spreadsheet]. Consequently, this is another form of modifying not only the power flow topology but also the location of equipment.
3-30
3-31
This option modifies the images of network components, replacing PSSE symbols with standard ISO symbols. Figure 3-25 shows the standard PSSE transformer symbol, compared with the ISO symbol.
PSSE Symbols
ISO Symbols
This function animates branch flows on the active [Diagram] using the flows from the last power flow solution (Figure 3-26).
3-32
This function displays line loading graphs using values from the last solution (Figure 3-27).
This function displays or hides the dummy buses that constitute the terminals of multiple sections that make up a single line between buses.
(b) Reporting On
3-33
3-34
Right-clicking on a load or a shunt capacitor/reactor opens the appropriate annotation properties dialog (see Figure 3-30). You can choose the type of image or annotation, suppression of annotationy, and application of the properties to all shunt or load items.
3-35
Right-clicking on a branch or 2-winding transformer transformer (the transformer symbol itself, not the transformer line) and selecting Item Annotation opens the [Branch Annotation Properties] or [Two-Winding Transformer Annotation Properties] (Figure 3-31) dialogs, respectively. These dialogs are similar, except that when selecting a nontransformer branch, only the Flow Annotation Options are available, with the option to draw a series capacitor symbol or circuit ID.
Figure 3-31. Branch / Two Winding Transformer Annotation Properties Dialogs 3-36 Siemens Energy, Inc., Power Technologies International
A separate dialog is provided for three-winding transformers, [Three-Winding Transformer Annotation Properties] (Figure 3-32).
Figure 3-32. Three-Winding Transformer Annotation Properties Dialog Dialogs are also available for annotating generators and multi-terminal dc lines (Figure 3-33) and FACTS devices (Figure 3-34).
3-37
3-38
3.6.16 Contouring
The [Contour Settings] dialog provides the means to control contouring used to visualize voltage violations and magnitude for bus, line or machine elements.
3-39
One of the following quantities must be specified along with the contour type:
Bus Element Voltage Magnitude, pu Voltage Magnitude, kV Angle deg MW Flow MVar Flow QGen Angle rad Load P Load Q MVA Flow % Rating QMax Load MVA Area Owner Ampe pu Current QMin Zone Scheduled Voltage
Line Element
Machine Element
The three contour parameters are selected from a sliding scale. Resolution Range 10 - 2000. To compute values across the entire contouring region, a virtual grid is super-imposed on the contour points. The value at each grid point is interpolated using actual values at the contour points. The weights are inversely proportional to the square of the distance from each contour point. Values at the grid points are then mapped to a color using the selected colormap before rendering is performed. A larger resolution results in a finer grid and more accurate results but also increases processing time.
Figure 3-36. 6 X 6 Virtual Grid Superimposed on Contour Points P1 P6 Influence Area Range 1 - 100. Each contour point impacts a circular region, centered at the point with radius proportional to the influence setting. In the current implementation, the radius is equal to the square of the influence. A larger influence results in more blending and can be used for general overviews. Smaller settings are applied to highlight variations as each grid point is affected by fewer contour points. By decreasing influence, each grid point will be affected less by contour points farther away.
3-40
Figure 3-37. Circle of Influence around Contour Point P1 Boundary Size Range 0 - 3. The typical setting is 0 or 1. The user must specify one of the following interpolation methods. Linear Approximation The Linear Approximation method iterates over all contour points. A given contour point contributes to each grid point that lies within its circle of influence. Larger circles take longer to process therefore processing time is sensitive to changes in influence rather than resolution. This algorithm is faster than the Linear method while providing accuracy and is the current default. The order of the algorithm is O(m) where m is the number of contour points.
Contour Point 1 Adds Contributions to G1, G2 and G3 Figure 3-38. Linear Approximation Method
3-41
Linear The Linear Method is the most accurate. Processing speed depends on the resolution of the grid. Values at each grid point are interpolated using all contour points within a certain distance. The contribution from each contour point is the value of the physical quantity being plotted weighted (inversely) by the square of its distance from the grid point. Thus the speed of the algorithm is O(n^2 * m) where n is the desired resolution and m is the number of contour points. The time taken by the Linear Method is therefore very sensitive to the resolution of the grid.
Grid Point 1 Receives Contributions from Contour Points 1, 2, 3 Figure 3-39. Linear Method Quad Tree This method subdivides the diagram into uneven sized grid cells with finer subdivision occurring in areas that exhibit greater variation. Processing efforts are focused on regions that show signs of larger differences in the physical quantity being plotted. This occurs at the expense of other areas that have more uniform values. The QuadTree method generally results in a more blended diagram. For small values of depth, contours are generated very quickly.
3-42
Figure 3-40. Non-Uniform Partitioning using the QuadTree Method The Depth and Tolerance settings are required for the quad tree interpolation method. Depth The Depth setting determines the maximum level of subdivision that will occur. Further partitioning of grid cells will not occur even if the current difference is greater than the user selected tolerance value. Tolerance Value The Tolerance Value is needed to end subdivision. For a given grid cell, the difference between the maximum and minimum at the corners is calculated. If it is less than the specified tolerance, no further splitting occurs. Otherwise, the grid cell is recursively subdivided further. The Enable Shading option can be disabled to create a non-shaded image. This is useful when viewing regions of finer subdivision resulting from the QuadTree partitioning. The Color Map options determine which values are to be displayed and the colors assigned to them. the Maximum and Minimum values are used as a filter. Any points that lie outside this range will be removed. The discarded quantities dont contribute to interpolated values at the grid points. This feature can be used to see variations within a desired range. The Gradient options translate interpolated values at grid points into colors. The maximum value is mapped to the topmost color and the minimum is gets assigned to the bottom color. The user selects from the following color options:
Red (dark to light) Green (dark to light) Blue (dark to light) GrayScale (dark to light) Blue=low Red=high (default) Red=low Blue=high
3-43
Helpful Hints The Linear Approximation method is recommended unless extreme accuracy is needed or only a generalized picture is desired. When using the Linear Approximation, start with the default influence setting. Smaller values highlight detailed variations better. Increase influence slowly and only as necessary. Larger influence values result in more blending and tell a more generalized story. When using the Linear method start with the default value for resolution, increase it slowly if any square-like artifacts appear. Once the artifacts are gone, a further increase in resolution can be tried if desired but after a certain point the law of diminishing returns goes into effect. Both Linear and Linear Approximation are sensitive to the number of contour points. For diagrams with large extents, larger influence values are needed. If at first no contours appear, try increasing the influence while keeping the resolution constant. If the contours appear but exhibit square-like grid cells, increase the resolution till you see a better picture. Use a Bounding Box of 0 or 1, especially for diagrams with large extents. To get a generalized view of a large area, use larger values for influence. As a general recommendation, start with defaults for influence and resolution. Increase each parameter only as needed while keeping the other constant to see the difference in the picture. Use the QuadTree method to get quick generalized pictures. Processing time is a combination of several factors in all cases. However the speed of the Linear Approximation method is affected mostly by the influence setting while that of the Linear method is determined by the resolution. Busbars and Branches are represented by several contour points, placed equally along the length. When plotting quantities for Busbars or Branches and using a minimum influence (value of 1) an oval effect is seen around the element being plotted. This is the union of all the circles centered at the contour points.
3-44
Tooltips are the pop-up informational boxes that appear when the mouse cursor is held over a component in the diagram. The Display Tooltips option in the [Diagram Properties] dialog must be enabled for tooltips to function (see Section 3.2). If the option to display tooltips is enabled, one of the three types of information can be displayed in the tooltip (see Figure 3-41). The example shows possible tooltips for a bus.
(a) ID Only
3-45
One of the features of [Diagram] is the ability to automatically build or expand one-line diagrams of power flow cases bus-by-bus or by groups of buses. This facilitates the rapid population of a blank [Diagram] with a one-line diagram of the open power flow case. Using the Auto Draw function will place a selected bus on the diagram graphically, and automatically draw adjacent equipment, including adjacent buses. The Auto Draw feature also allows the specification of the number of bus levels to extend out of the first bus. Auto Draw will draw and connect these buses and neighboring facilities of all of these buses. The user has two options to draw a diagram quickly. The first approach involves the following steps: 1. Open a blank diagram (see Section 3.3). 2. Select the Auto Draw button and click in [Diagram] to set the bus position. The [Select Bus for Auto-Draw] dialog (Figure 3-42) opens. 3. Select or specify the bus to grow and the number of levels to grow out from this bus. For example, using the savnw.sav power flow case, bus 101 has been selected and grown two levels (see Figure 3-42). The bus, all its equipment, all lines, transformers, and attached buses are then laid out in [Diagram]. In the example, Bus 101 bus and its one neighboring bus are drawn, along with their attached equipment and connecting transformer branch. If a Bus Location file has been opened and the Use Bus Location file to AutoDraw/Grow items option on the [Program Preferences] dialog has been selected (see Section 3.6.8), the buses will be placed at the locations specified in the Bus Location file. If the bus location data for the bus does not exist or the option is disabled, then the bus will be placed at the default location. The process could be continued by selecting locations on the diagram and bus numbers from the [Select Bus for Auto-Draw] dialog. If, in this example, bus 152 were the next one selected and one level was grown out of this bus, the diagram would grow to include the other attached buses to bus 152, which are buses 153, 202, and 3004, their connected equipment, and the branches from these buses back to bus 152.
3-46
Figure 3-42. Drawing Bus 101 and Buses Two Levels Out, using the Auto Draw Toolbar Button The second approach to start drawing a diagram is to reverse the order of actions, as follows: 1. Select (highlight) the desired starting bus in [Network Tree]. 2. Click the Auto Draw button from the Diagram Toolbar. 3. Click in [Diagram] to place the bus. If the first bus selected in [Network Tree] was bus 101, the result would be bus 101 and 151 plus all equipment attached to either bus. The process could be continued by selecting other buses from [Network Tree]. If there is a bus or buses already drawn on the one-line diagram it is possible to use the Grow option from [Network Tree] to add more one more level of buses. Also, the Grow N Levels option can be used to add multiple levels of buses to the diagram. Right-click the bus in [Diagram] (see Figure 311). Selecting Grow N Levels on either of these menus will initiate the drawing of all buses attached to the bus selected, along with the connected equipment and the branches back to the selected bus
3-47
N levels out from the bus. This method assists in rapidly creating a one-line diagram of the open power flow case. If a connecting bus or branch already exists on the diagram when a Grow is performed, any new connections will be made to the existing equipment.
When buses are added to [Diagram] using Auto Draw or by selecting the Grow option described in Section 3.6, the buses will be drawn either horizontally or vertically. This function permits shifting between vertical and horizontal bus representations as the one-line diagram is being developed
3-48
Superimposing power flow results on a one-line diagram is an effective means of presentation. This section will highlight some of those features on the assumption that a slider diagram (*.sld) has been created. The following examples use the savnw.sav and savnw.sld files provided in the Example folder of the PSSE installation. A portion of the network power flow results can be seen in Figure 3-43. Here the annotation is selected to show: Bus name and number with voltages shown in pu and kV Branch flows at to and from ends Transformer taps on both sides MW and Mvar flows on branches and in equipment Signs as opposed to arrows to show flow directions. Plus signs indicate flows out of a bus and minus signs indicate flows into a bus.
3-49
Results of a power flow analysis may be modified as a whole for presentation using a set of annotation dialogs. For example, the user can choose to show all the information in Figure 3-43 for all buses, branches and equipment, including generation, or to globally prevent showing of particular types of information (such as no branch flows on all branches) or to select particular buses, lines and equipment to have their annotation suppressed. The right-click menu applied to a selected diagram item opens a specific annotation dialog for that item (see also Sections 3.6.5 and 3.6.15). When power flow results are shown, the [Powerflow Data Annotation] dialog provides a Diagram Annotations tab (Figure 3-44) to modify the presentation for printing or to save to a file.
3-50
Options include the type of results annotation information to be displayed for branches, buses and equipment. The user can represent flows on the branches with either signs or arrows (see Figure 345). The real power, in each case is shown above the branch.
(a) Signs
(b) Arrows
3-51
Figure 3-46. Diagram Range Checking Tab Use voltage level thresholds: When enabled, this option indicates equipment and lines based on voltage level. Threshold levels may be specified by entering a value directly in the input field or using the scroll buttons. Click the sample line corresponding to each threshold to open a [Voltage level] dialog for each threshold (Figure 3-47) to change line styles and colors. Click the palette button to open the [Color] dialog (Figure 3-3).
3-52
Figure 3-47. Voltage Level Dialog Use line ratings: When enabled, this option indicates lines that are loaded above the specified percent loading value. Click the sample line to open a [Line ratings appearance] dialog (Figure 348) to change line style and color. Click the palette button to open the [Color] dialog (Figure 3-3).
Figure 3-48. Line Ratings Appearance Dialog Branch Rating Set: This option provides a pull-down list of branch ratings to which the % loading value is to be applied. Rate A is typically used for normal power flow conditions while Rate B or C would be used to examine contingency conditions where loadings are often allowed to be higher. Use bus voltage limits: When enabled, this option indicates buses with voltages above or below specified maximum and minimum voltage levels. Click the sample line to open the [Bus voltage limit appearance] dialog (Figure 3-49) to change line style and color. Click the palette button to open the [Color] dialog (Figure 3-3).
3-53
Figure 3-49. Bus Voltage Limit Appearance Dialog Out-of-service equipment: This setting indicates status of out-of-service equipment. Click the sample line to open the [Out-of-service equipment appearance] dialog (Figure 3-50) to change line style and color. Click the palette button to open the [Color] dialog (Figure 3-3).
Figure 3-50. Out-of-Service Equipment Appearance Dialog Loading percentages for loading bar charts: These fields are used to control the percentage at which overload colors are applied to the loading bar charts. Overload colors by default progress from purple to red to deeper shades of red. Click [ ] to open the [Color] dialog to modify these colors. The following example shows that that buses 206 and 3018 (and others) are highlighted for having voltages in excess of the high limit, specified at 1.02 pu. Bus 203 and 205 are highlighted for having voltages below the low limit, 0.97 pu. The circuit one between buses 153 and 154 (and others) are highlighted to show their loading is in excess of 90% of their Rate A.
3-54
3-55
The user can clarify the power flow results visualization by including a summation block for flow information. This could be useful to report current results when testing a variety of network conditions. The [Edit Summation] dialog provides fields for a title line for the summation and a variety of system results to sum. For example, these can be generator output and line flows. The example in Figure 3-52 sums the difference between generator output at bus 101 and the flow on circuit 1 of the line from bus 151 to 201. The summation block is placed in [Diagram] at the point selected by the user. Subsequently, it can be edited and/or moved to a different location.
Figure 3-52. Edit Summation Dialog To cancel the summation activity, press the [Esc] key. Refer to PSSE Program Operation Manual, Summation Block Structure for additional information.
3-56
The user can clarify the power flow results visualization by including a report node to display any type of information that may be of importance. This could be useful to report current results when testing a variety of network conditions. The report node is Python based. Python code can be written to calculate and return any value, using existing Python APIs, that may be of interest to the user. The [Edit Report Node] dialog provides fields for a title line for the report node, passing arguments to Python, defining the Python function, and defining the Python module that contains the Python function. The example in Figure 3-53 shows the definition of a report node called Area Summary:, using the Python function area_summary, in the Python module pssgrpg, passing 1 as an argument. The report node is placed in [Diagram] at the point selected by the user. Subsequently, it can be edited and/or moved to a different location. To cancel the report node activity, press the [Esc] key.
3-57
3-58
This function displays impedance and equipment rating data. By default the diagram displays the generator scheduled power and the reactive power limits. Bus information includes the bus number, name and base kV. Line and transformer information shows the R, X and B values, as appropriate, and the transformer tap information is included.
3-59
Figure 3-55. Impedance Data Annotation Dialog Bus, branch, and equipment annotations, as well as voltage level thresholds are available in the impedance data annotation.
3-60
The [Compare Cases on a Diagram] dialog (Figure 3-56) requires the specification of a saved case against which to compare the working case. Click [ ] to open the selection window for the required Saved Case file (*.sav). Click [OK] to perform the activity. A summary of the comparison is routed to the Report tab.
Figure 3-56. Compare Cases on a Diagram Dialog Differences in solution results and bus boundary conditions between the current power flow case and the selected saved case are displayed. Differences are always calculated as comparison case values minus power flow case values. At each bus in the bus comparison list, voltage differences in per unit and phase angle differences in degrees are shown. All other difference values are shown in MW and Mvar. An example diagram is shown in (Figure 3-57).
3-61
Figure 3-57. Example of Case Comparison Differences The difference fields are left blank for equipment items present in the power flow case, but not in the comparison case. Those items present in the comparison case that are not included in the power flow case are omitted from the diagram. Load and shunt differences include voltage sensitivity effects. Differences in flow into a converter bus of DC line n are shown if all of the following conditions apply: DC line n is present in both cases. The converter bus is in the bus compare list. The same converter bus is specified in both cases.
Two-terminal dc lines are annotated according to the annotation properties currently set in the diagram. Differences in the sending end bus shunt element of FACTS device n are shown if all of the following conditions apply: FACTS device n is present in both cases. The sending end bus is in the bus compare list. The same sending end bus is specified in both cases.
If the above conditions are satisfied and FACTS device n has a series element in the power flow case, differences in series flow at the sending end bus are also shown. Differences in series flow at the terminal end bus are shown if all of the following conditions apply: FACTS device n is present and has a series element in both cases. The terminal end bus is in the bus compare list. The same terminal end bus is specified in both cases.
3-62
(Figure 3-58).
Figure 3-58. Graphical Case Comparison Data Annotation Dialog Only bus annotation and voltage thresholds are available in the case comparison annotation.
3-63
Reading Sequence Data for Fault Analysis Calculating Automatic Sequencing Fault
If the calculation has been performed, the results may be displayed in [Diagram].
Only the voltage thresholds are available in the fault analysis annotation.
3-64
Reading Sequence Data for Fault Analysis Calculating Short Circuit Currents According to IEC 60909 Standard
If the calculation has been performed, the results may be displayed in [Diagram].
3-65
If the calculations have been performed, the results may be displayed in [Diagram].
One of three data categories can be displayed one a time on the reliability diagram; they are contingency solution, deterministic reliability results, and probabilistic reliability results. Under each data category, several data quantities are available. When a data category does not exist in the reliability assessment analysis, the corresponding option is disabled. To display bus voltage violations, a voltage limit record and either its lower or upper limit must be specified. [Diagram] displays voltage violations for only one monitored voltage limit record at a time.
3-66
Figure 3-61. Reliability Analysis Annotation Dialog Figure 3-62 shows branch flow overloads. Only monitored branches have values and are shown in the diagram. Overloaded circuits are branches from bus 154 to bus 203 and from bus 154 to bus 205. Note that the results shown in the diagram are calculated on the basis of contingency analysis results and specified options in reliability assessment. (e.g rating set, percent loading, cutoff values of frequency and probability). In this example, branch flow overloading probabilistic indices are on the basis of 100% of rating A. Modifying the rating of any of the following parameters requires redoing reliability assessment to refresh the diagram view. Normalizing probability option Rating set Cutoff values of frequency and probability Outage statistic data
Similarly, for voltage violations and load curtailment results, reliability assessment should be performed again if any of following parameters are changed: Normalizing probability option Cutoff values of frequency and probability Outage statistic data
3-67
Figure 3-62. Example of Branch Flow Overloading Probabilistic Reliability Results Figure 3-63 shows bus load curtailment probabilistic results. Expected unserved energy at buses 153 and 154 are 5546.6 MWH/Y and 8480.8MWH/Y respectively.
3-68
After the calculations have been performed, the results may be displayed in [Diagram]. In the following example (Figure 3-64), Bus 206 is displayed before and after analysis.
3-69
3-70 Siemens Energy, Inc., Power Technologies International a. Before Dynamic Analysis b. Results of Dynamic Analysis Displayed on Diagram Figure 3-64. Example of Diagram View Showing Difference between Bus Display and Bus Display with Dynamic Analysis Results
Figure 3-65. Dynamics Simulation Annotation Dialog Annotation options may be selected for either Voltage Violations or Contours.
3-71
This function provides the means to create a one-line drawing starting with a single bus. Enter the desired bus number in the [Select Bus] dialog (Figure 3-66) and click [OK]. A diagram of power flow results is generated for the selected bus, showing associated lines and equipment and distant to buses. All distant buses are represented as nodes (Figure 3-67).
3-72
All [Diagram] functions are available using the single bus display. Thus, selecting Diagram > Results > Impedance data and the Current loadings icon from the active diagram in Figure 3-67 produces the example shown in Figure 3-68. Switching and data changing functions are available for any data display.
Figure 3-68. Example of Single Bus Display, Impedance Data The single bus display is also available from [Network Spreadsheet]. Select the desired Bus Number on the Buses tab, right-click, and select Create bus display (GOUT/GEXM). The default view (Power Flow Results) is displayed.
3-73
3-74
Any series FACTS device connected to the selected bus is drawn to the right of the bus with a line connecting that bus and its associated terminal/send bus. The series element is illustrated by a circle containing an embedded arrow and is located midway on the connecting line. The arrow indicates the power flow direction (sending end bus to terminal end bus direction). The FACTS device number is displayed to the right of the connected bus. For series FACTS devices with non-zero shunt current and/or bridge active power transfer limits, when the selected bus is the sending end bus, two additional lines are drawn to represent the shunt and bridge element connections. The first line is drawn to the right of the sending end bus underneath the series element connecting line and stops at a point midway between the sending end bus and the terminal end bus. Another line is drawn from that point upward to the series element circle.
3-75
3-76
Single bus display diagrams are used for quickly traversing the network. A diagram originally created with GOUT/GEXM will respond to growing elements differently from a diagram created using Auto-Draw or Grow (see Section 3.7, Using Auto-Draw). During a Grow operation they simply display everything connected to the bus. The Grow operations pays no attention to whether or not the element exists in [Diagram]; the item is simply created again to lend clarity to the layout. This function can be used to convert the grow behavior of a diagram from GOUT/GEXM to an AutoDraw style grow where each specific element only is created once. This option is available only when a [Diagram] is the active view.
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
Section 10.34, Displaying Power Flow Solution on the Diagram Section 10.35, Displaying Power Flow Data on the Diagram
3-77
This activity generates the old GRPG-style report. The [Graphical Report Data file] selection window requires entering the filename of an existing Graphical Report Data file (*.grp). The [Terminal Read] dialog (Figure 3-70) then requires a code for the output device. The most common response is 26, directing the output to the screen. Future releases will provide support for GPRG style reporting directly from [Diagram].
3-78
3-79
The [Diagram Contents] screen presents an itemized list of the number of components in the entire diagram, including diagram items, annotations, images, and text annotations added by the user (Figure 3-72).
This function examines the entire network and diagram for apparent errors and missing items. The results are displayed in the Progress tab (Figure 3-73). To examine the network by subsystem, select Diagram > Check by Subsystem.
3-80
A simple way to visualize layers is to imagine [Diagram] as an infinite number of sheets of clear mylar, stacked on top of another. Diagram items are drawn on a single sheet of mylar, that is, they belong to a particular layer. When all sheets are laid down, [Diagram] is seen in its entirety. This function opens the [Layers] dialog (Figure 3-74).
Figure 3-74. Layers Dialog PSSE provides the capability to view selected layers. For example, layers could be defined for base voltages of 110 kV, 200 kV, and 300 kV. The diagram items that correspond to these base voltages could then be created on the appropriate layer. To view the entire network, all layers would be made visible. To view only the 200 kV elements, the 100 kV and 300 kV layers would be made invisible, leaving only the 200 kV layer visible. At a minimum, [Diagram] contains two layers: Layer 0: The background layer with any imported images. Layer 1: The default layer.
You can change attributes in these layers, but they cannot be removed from [Diagram]. All new diagram items added to [Diagram] are created on the active layer, which is the single layer specified. Even if all layers are visible, only one is considered the active layer. It is displayed in the Status bar at the bottom of the PSSE interface when [Layers] is closed (Figure 3-75).
3-81
Figure 3-75. Status Bar Showing Active Layer Click [Add] to specify a new layer. You may create a unique title by modifying the Layer description field. Clicking another layer or [Close] saves the layer attributes, which may be modified. Highlight a layer and click [Remove the last] to delete it. The visibility of the layers depends on the options selected in [Layers]. Fixed: The layer is in the diagram file. It is visible if the Visible checkbox is selected. Zoom-dependent: The current zooming factor determines layer visibility. If the current zooming factor is within the minimum and maximum zooming factors specified, then the layer is visible. If the zooming factor is outside the range, then the layer is invisible. The Items are selectable checkbox enables the ability to highlight specific components of a layer. To avoid the inadvertent manipulation of certain diagram components, place them on a separate layer and deselect the checkbox. To set the active layer, go to Diagram > Set Active Layer and select the desired layer from the pulldown list in the [Select Layer] dialog (Figure 3-76).
Figure 3-76. Setting the Active Layer To assign network components to a layer, select the component and right-click to display the menu. Select Display > Assign to Layer and select the desired layer from the pull-down list in [Select Layer]. This method can be used to assign diagram items to a layer one at a time, or a group of items can be selected and all be assigned to a layer. In the following example, all diagram items from Area 1 of the savnw.sav power flow case have been selected and assigned to a layer with the name Area 1 To see the entire one-line diagram, select all layers to be visible (see Figure 3-77). If the Area 1 layer is selected to be not visible, the one-line diagram will show only the diagram items belonging to the Default layer (see Figure 3-78).
3-82
Figure 3-78. Only Default Visible Layer assignment may also be made from [Network Tree]. Right-clicking the network folder opened to an expanded list will display a pop-up menu with an Assign all items to Layer option. This function opens [Select Layer]. When the layer is selected, all drawn items in the expanded list are re-assigned and [Diagram] is refreshed. This tool can be useful for assigning network items to layers for an existing or imported diagram.
3-83
This function selects all items in the diagram that have had color, line style, or line width established in Specifying Diagram Properties or Range Checking replaced by [Color] or [Line Style] dialogs (Figure 3-3 and Figure 3-16).
Diagram > Remove property overrides from selected items
This function removes any property overrides from selected items in the diagram. The line style, width and color will return to those specified by Specifying Diagram Properties or Range Checking.
This function performs a general diagram cleanup. As bugs are discovered in existing diagrams, new cleaning modes are added to this function and released in program patches so that users will be able to repair their diagrams. Repeatedly executing this activity will have no effect on a diagram, it addresses only specific diagram issues. The current issues addressed are: 1. Makes sure any name extension is separated by a from the end of the internally generated name. 2. Removes any unattached Branch or Radial symbols. 3. Checks for Summations that have lost their Identity strings. 4. Fixes any bad annotation tags found on branches and two winding transformers.
3-84
You may export the visible area of an active diagram to either a Bitmap or a JPEG file. The [Export Image As] dialog requires the name of the file in which to save the image and navigation to the desired directory for file storage. When the JPEG file type is selected, the export process requires the specification of the JPEG quality level on a scale of 1 to 100 (see Figure 3-79). Some experimentation may be necessary to find the desired level of quality, balanced with file size.
You may export the x/y coordinates from all buses, branches, and two winding transformers in the active diagram to a text file. Bus, branch and two winding transformer locations are recorded as Cartesian coordinates. The [Select bus location output file] dialog requires the name of the file (*.loc) in which to save the data and navigation to the desired directory for file storage.
You may export slider diagrams to KML (Keyhole Markup Language) format. Geographic Coordinate information in the WGS-84 (World Geodetic System) is required for graphical elements that will be exported. The KML file can then be opened and manipulated in Google Earth. This feature allows a power network to be viewed against the backdrop of location specific, geographic data. The [Select Google Earth data output file] dialog requires the name of the file (*.kml) in which to save the data and navigation to the desired directory for file storage.
3-85
The Close option provides the opportunity to save any changes made to the diagram since it was last opened.
The Save option over-writes a previous version of the file. If a new diagram is to be saved, the [Save As] dialog requires a filename and the specification of file type: either Slider Binary file (*.sld), the standard format, or Slider XML file (*.sldxml), an XML text file.
3-86
3-87
3-88
Chapter 4
Data Selection Tree View
4.1 Introduction
The [Tree] view provides a hierarchical, expandable and collapsible list view of the network, OPF, dynamics, model, and plot data in the working case (see Figure 4-1). Folders can be expanded or collapsed to control the amount of data visible. Only one folder may be expanded at a time. A right-click in a blank area of [Tree] (without selecting a data category) will display a menu from which hiding/exposing and docking/undocking the view can be selected. Hide: Closes the view. The user must select View > Tree View to reopen it. Allow Docking: Toggles between docking the view and making it a free-floating window.
4-1
When [Diagram] is active, the data items in [Network Tree] are updated to reflect whether a particular item is drawn in the diagram. If the item is not drawn, then the symbol to the left of the item is blank. If the item is drawn, the symbol to the left of the item is filled with the symbol belonging to the data category (i.e., busbar, load symbol, etc.). When [Diagram] is active, data record property sheets can be opened by double-clicking a data items in [Network Tree]. See Section 3.6.1, Using Data Records. The symbols in [Network Tree] are refreshed whenever [Diagram] is made active. A network item can be drawn in one diagram and not another, so the symbols provide a visual cue indicating whether the network item is drawn in the active diagram (see Figure 4-2). When [Spreadsheet] is active, all symbols are replaced with blanks.
Figure 4-2. Tree View, Buses in Active Diagram Various menus are available by selecting and right-clicking a network component. Menus are specific to the type of network element selected (see Figure 4-3).
4-2
Figure 4-3. Some Tree View Menu Options Switch: Toggles in-service status; that is, disconnects the device. Sort: All items in the selected data category are sorted in ascending alphanumeric order. Network Data: Points to the selected network component in [Network Spreadsheet] on the relevant data tab, and highlights its data row. Dynamics Data: Points to the selected network component in [Dynamics Spreadsheet] on the relevant data tab, and highlights its data row. Delete: Deletes the network component from the model. Create bus subsystem: Filter the model by a set of selected buses. Create area subsystem: Filter the model by a set of selected areas. Create zone subsystem: Filter the model by a set of selected zones. Create owner subsystem: Filter the model by a set of selected owners. If [Diagram] is the active view, then the right-click menu for the selected element provides additional options. These are described in detail in Section 3.6.4, Binding Data, Section 3.6.5, Displaying and Modifying Network Elements, Section 3.6.6, Drawing a Missing Bus, Section 3.7, Using Auto-Draw, and Section 3.17.3, Diagram Layers. Double-clicking a component activates [Network Spreadsheet], opens the correct data tab, and highlights its data row.
4-3
Figure 4-4. OPF Tree View All network elements that have OPF data associated with them will have an entry in the appropriate folder in the OPF tab. Double-clicking a data element (i.e., a particular bus) activates [OPF Spreadsheet], opens the correct data tab, and highlights the spreadsheet data row for the selected item. [OPF Tree] displays only network elements for which OPF data has been defined, either through opening an Optimal Power Flow data file or by initializing OPF data in the current working case (see Section 19.2, Data Initialization for OPF).
4-4
Figure 4-5. Dynamics Tree View All network elements that have Dynamics models associated with them will have an entry in the appropriate folder in the Dynamics tab. Double-clicking a data element (i.e., a particular machine) activates [Dynamics Spreadsheet], opens the correct data tab, and highlights the spreadsheet data row for the selected item. [Dynamics Tree] only displays network elements for which Dynamics models have been defined, either through opening a Snapshot or DYRE file or through [Dynamics Spreadsheet].
4-5
Figure 4-6. Models Tree View The Models tab is organized by Dynamics model types e.g. Generators, Stabilizers etc. Each model type contains a list of all models of that type present in the current network. The example in Figure 4-6 shows that there are three types of exciter models present in the current network, SEXS, SCRX and IEEET1. Double-clicking a model activates [Models Spreadsheet] opened to the CONS tab of the selected model.
4-6
Figure 4-7. Plot Tree Further details on using the integrated plot package can be found in Chapter 22, Dynamic Simulation PlotPackage.
4-7
4-8
Chapter 5
Tools
The Tools Menu allows the user to designate active toolbars, to select the icons (activity commands) that are to be shown on each toolbar, to define Custom Toolbar buttons, to assign model search paths, and to create the User Dynamics DLL. Toolbar icons are indexed in Appendix A.
The [Customize] dialog Toolbars tab (Figure 5-1) allows arrangement of the toolbars to suit your modeling requirements. Toolbars can be turned on or off, and icons can be added or removed from them. Custom toolbars can also be created.
5-1
Use the checkboxes to enable/disable displays of the default toolbar arrangements. You may choose whether or not to show tooltip messages identifying each buttons function when the mouse pointer is held over it. Toolbars can be rearranged in any position on the interface. They can also be dragged off the toolbar location and converted into floating windows. Many of the toolbar buttons (or toolbar commands) are duplicates of menu options and will open the same dialog. The Commands tab (Figure 5-2) displays the individual toolbar categories and shows the buttons currently assigned to each toolbar. Click an icon to provide a description of its command function. The example displays Show or hide the output bar. To remove a button from an active toolbar, drag the icon from the toolbar to the Buttons area on the Commands tab. To add a button to an active toolbar, by drag the icon from the the Buttons area on the Commands tab to the desired location on the toolbar.
5-2
The [Customize Toolbar Buttons] dialog lists available custom toolbar buttons and active toolbar buttons (see Figure 5-3). These can be defined to execute user-specified commands.
Figure 5-3. Customize Toolbar Buttons Dialog Thirty custom toolbar buttons are available. Each button requires a file type and a file name. To define a toolbar button, highlight a button and assign a File Type, one of the following Automation file types to be run when the button is clicked: PYTHON - A Python script file (*.py) (default) RESPONSE - A Response file (*.idv) IPLAN - An IPLAN program (*.irf)
Click [ ] to open the [Open] selection window to specify the filename of the Automation file to be executed when clicking the corresponding custom toolbar button. Make sure the Full Pathname of File appears in the field. You may specify a description (tooltip) of the operation to be performed when the corresponding custom toolbar button is clicked in the optional Text To Display field. This description pops up when the mouse cursor is held over the custom toolbar button. If a tooltip is not specified, the filename associated with the button is displayed as a tooltip. Click [Update] to apply the changes that youve made. The arrows in the center of the dialog move buttons from being available to being active. Figure Figure 5-4 shows the results of several defined buttons, two of which are in the active list.
5-3
Figure 5-4. Defined Toolbar Buttons The button must be in the Active Buttons list to be available on the toolbar. The others will be grayed out (Figure 5-5).
Figure 5-5. Custom Toolbar Showing Defined Buttons These custom toolbar button definitions are preserved in a file named Toolbar.prm found in the Windows Document and Settings directory for the active user.
5-4
Figure 5-6. New Toolbar Dialog To add command buttons to the new toolbar, click the Commands tab and drag the desired toolbar buttons to the new toolbar window. The new toolbar window can be docked to the toolbar area by dragging the window to the desired location on the toolbar and releasing the mouse. To remove a user-defined toolbar from the list of toolbars on the Toolbars tab, highlight the desired toolbar to be deleted and click [Delete]. The standard toolbars can be reset only to their default settings.
5-5
5-6
Chapter 6
Power Flow Data Entry
6.1 Retrieving a Power Flow Saved Case File
Activity CASE
Requirements / Prerequisites Saved Case file (*.sav)
The case retrieval activity CASE restores the contents of a previously saved power flow Saved Case File into the working case. The contents of the working case are overwritten while the contents of the specified Saved Case File are unchanged. The file selection window in the [Open] dialog lists only those files available when the Files of type: field has been scrolled to the desired file type. For this activity, scroll to Save Case file (*.sav). Highlight the desired file and click [Open]. After the data is read into the working case, [Spreadsheet] is updated to include the new working case data.
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
6-1
Selecting the Powerflow Save cases option from [File Information] produces a report of power flow case filenames in the current working directory.
6-2
Power Flow Data Entry Reading Power Flow Raw Data into the Working Case
6.3 Reading Power Flow Raw Data into the Working Case
The bulk power flow data input activity READ picks up hand-typed power flow source data and enters it into the power flow working case, rearranging it from its original format into a computationally oriented data structure in the process. The source data records are input from a Power Flow Raw Data file. After the data is read into the working case, [Spreadsheet] is updated to include the new working case data.
The file selection window in the [Open] dialog lists only those files available when the Files of type: field has been scrolled to the desired file type. For a standard READ of a Power Flow Raw Data File in the format of the PSSE release indicated in the file, scroll to Power Flow Raw Data file (*.raw), highlight the desired file, and then click [Open]. In the specified Power Flow Raw Data file, fields designating ac buses on load, generator, fixed shunt, branch, transformer, area, two-terminal dc line, VSC dc line, multi-terminal dc line, multisection line, FACTS device, and switched shunt data records must be specified as bus numbers. A standard READ may also be initiated by using the Power Flow Raw Data file, Options (*.raw) entry in the Files of type: list. Highlight the desired file and then click [Open]. In the resulting [Read Power Flow Raw Data] dialog, select Standard (READ) as the Power flow data input application. In the RAW file version fields, the current or a prior PSSE release corresponding to the format of the Power Flow Raw Data File must be indicated. When the revision number is specified in the file, specify the current version; if some other version is specified, it will take precedence over that specified as REV on the first record of the Power Flow Raw Data File. The For input, use bus names check box must be checked if the selected Power Flow Raw Data File contains any bus data fields specified as extended bus names. Then click [OK].
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
Section 5.2, Reading Power Flow Raw Data into the Working Case PSSE Application Program Interface (API) Section 1.190, READ Section 1.191, READRAWVERSION
See also:
6-3
Power Flow Data Entry Reading Power Flow Raw Data into the Working Case
The file selection window in the [Open] dialog lists only those files available when the Files of type: field has been scrolled to the desired file type. For a subsystem READ of a Power Flow Raw Data File, scroll to Power Flow Data file, Options (*.raw), highlight the desired file, and click [Open]. In the resulting [Read Power Flow Raw Data] dialog (Figure 6-2), select Stubsystem (READ,OPT) as the Power flow data input application. In the RAW file version fields, the current or a prior PSSE release corresponding to the format of the Power Flow Raw Data File must be indicated. When the revision number is specified in the file, specify the current version; if some other version is specified, it will take precedence over that specified as REV on the first record of the Power Flow Raw Data File. The For input, use bus names check box must be checked if the selected Power Flow Raw Data File contains any bus data fields specified as extended bus names. The Input by Subsystem fields allow the selection of the options described in Section 5.2.4, Subsystem READ of the PSSE Program Operation Manual. Data input may be limited to any of the following options: Add only data within subsystem Add only tie lines from subsystem Add subsystem data + tie lines
The various subsystem selection checkboxes enable the specification of the subsystem by base voltage, area, owner, and/or zone. Clicking [Select] for an active option opens the [Area Subsystem Selector], [Owner Subsystem Selector], or [Zone Subsystem Selector] dialog, as appropriate. With all options selected, click [OK] to begin reading the data into the working case.
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
Section 5.2, Reading Power Flow Raw Data into the Working Case PSSE Application Program Interface (API) Section 1.192, READSUB Section 1.193, READSUBRAWVERSION See also: Section 10.4, Creating a Power Flow Raw Data File
6-4
Power Flow Data Entry Reading Power Flow Raw Data into the Working Case
6-5
The bulk power flow data input and modification activity RDCH picks up manually-entered power flow source data and enters it into the power flow working case. The source data records are in the form of a Power Flow Raw Data File except that the Case Identification Data records are omitted; that is, the first data record is expected to be a bus data record. The file selection window in the [Open] dialog lists only those files available when the Files of type: field has been scrolled to the desired file type. For activity RDCH, scroll to Power Flow Data file, Options (*.raw), highlight the desired file, and click [Open]. In the resulting [Read Power Flow Raw Data] dialog (Figure 6-3), select Change (RDCH) as the Power flow data input application. In the RAW file version fields, the current or a prior PSSE release corresponding to the format of the Power Flow Raw Data File must be indicated. The For input, use bus names check box must be checked if the selected Power Flow Raw Data File contains any bus data fields specified as extended bus names. Then click [OK]. After the data is read into the working case, [Spreadsheet] is updated to include the new working case data.
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
Section 5.7, Reading / Changing Power Flow Data PSSE Application Program Interface (API) Section 1.186, RAWD_2 Section 1.188, RDCHRAWVERSION See also: Section 10.4, Creating a Power Flow Raw Data File
6-6
6-7
Power Flow Data Entry Selecting Extended Bus Name Input Format
The extended bus name format was changed at PSSE Version 30 to accommodate longer bus names. This activity allows the user to select the input format for older versions of PSSE. All application functions that process buses based on the extended bus name will use the selected format for processing. This setting is not preserved between runs of the application.
6-8
The machine impedance data input activity MCRE enters source data records from a Machine Impedance Data File into the power flow working case. The file selection window in the [Open] dialog lists only those files available when the Files of type: field has been scrolled to the desired file type. For activity MCRE, scroll to Machine Impedance Data file (*.rwm). Highlight the desired file and click [Open]. In the resulting [Machine Impedance Data] dialog, select the options for the setting of the status of each new machine and for the treatment of existing machines with no input record. Then click [OK]. After the data is read into the working case, [Spreadsheet] is updated to include the new working case data.
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
Section 5.4, Adding Machine Impedance Data E Application Program Interface (API), Section 1.103, MCRE PSS See also: Section 10.3, Saving Machine Impedance Data
6-9
Power Flow Data Entry Reading Sequence Data for Fault Analysis
The sequence data input activity RESQ appends positive, negative, and zero sequence generator data and zero sequence network data to the working case in preparation for unbalanced network solutions (i.e., fault analysis). The source data records are read from a Sequence Data File for the system whose positive sequence representation is contained in the working case. The file selection window in the [Open] dialog lists only those files available when the Files of type: field has been scrolled to the desired file type. For activity RESQ, scroll to Sequence Data file (*.seq). Highlight the desired file and click [Open]. After the data is read into the working case, [Spreadsheet] is updated to include the new working case data.
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
PSSE Application Program Interface (API), Section 1.200, RESQ See also: Section 10.5, Creating a Sequence Data File
6-10
Transaction data is introduced into working memory using activity REMM. This information consists of data records presented in a Transactions Raw Data File. The file selection window in the [Open] dialog lists only those files available when the Files of type: field has been scrolled to the desired file type. For activity REMM, scroll to Transactions Raw Data file (*.mwm). Highlight the desired file and click [Open]. The data is read into the working case.
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
Section 5.6, Reading Transactions Raw Data See also: Section 10.6, Creating a Transactions Raw Data File
6-11
The long title data input activity RETI reads a data file containing up to 16 lines of alphanumeric data and places them into the long title. The previous content of the long title is overwritten. Activity RETI opens a file selection dialog with the title [Select file containing long case title]. The file selector contains all entries in your working directory (see Establishing the Working Directory). Select the desired file and click [Open] to import the long title into the working case.
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
Section 5.3, Reading Power Flow Data Additions from the Terminal PSSE Application Program Interface (API), Section 1.202, RETI
6-12
The [Case Titles] dialog provides fields where the two-line case title and the 16-line long title may be edited using standard windows techniques.
6-13
6-14
Chapter 7
Power Flow Data Modification
PSSE allows the user to modify the original network model in a variety of ways. Network elements can be added and removed either on an individual basis or in bulk. Network buses can be renumbered. Transmission resistance elements can be updated. Separate power flow files can be merged. Generation dispatch can be based on economic data. Existing network topology can be modified.
7-1
Power Flow Data Modification Changing Service Status and Power Flow Parametric Data
The working case must contain a validly specified power flow case.
PSSE permits the user to change all service status, control mode, and other parametric data associated with equipment represented in the working case. In the GUI, the primary means of changing individual data items is the [Spreadsheet] (refer to Spreadsheet View).
Additional Information
PSSE Program Operation Manual, Section 5.8, Changing Service Status and Power Flow Parametric Data
7-2
The working case must contain a validly specified power flow case.
The bus disconnection activity DSCN automates the data changes required to electrically isolate a bus. The bus reconnection activity RECN automates the data changes required to electrically reconnect a bus. The [Disconnect / Reconnect Bus] dialog (Figure 7-2) requires specification of the desired action and the bus to be connected. The bus number or extended bus name, as established by the bus input program option setting (refer to Saved Case Specific Option Settings of the PSSE Program Operation Manual), may be entered in the input field. Alternatively, [Select...] may be used to open the [Bus Selection] dialog (Figure 7-3) where the desired bus may be specified by double-clicking on an entry in the selection list; click [Filter] to open a [Bus Filter] dialog (Figure 7-4) to apply filtering criteria to limit the number of buses in the selection list.
7-3
Figure 7-3. Bus Selection Dialog Click [Filter] to open the [Bus Filter] dialog (Figure 7-4).
Figure 7-4. Bus Filter Dialog Select one or more of the filtering criteria from among: bus name mask bus number range base voltage range bus type code
Click [OK] to go back to [Bus Selection] with the selected filtering options enforced. Click [Go] on [Disconnect / Reconnect Bus] to implement the selected action.
7-4
Additional Information
PSSE Program Operation Manual, Section 5.10, Electrically Disconnecting a Bus Section 5.11, Electrically Reconnecting a Bus PSSE Application Program Interface (API) Section 1.49, DSCN Section 1.194, RECN
7-5
The working case must contain a validly specified power flow case.
The bus joining activity JOIN enables the user to combine pairs of buses, retaining the identity of one of the two buses. The [Join Buses] dialog (Figure 7-7) requires identification of the two buses to be joined and the specification of the line shunt treatment option. Either bus numbers or extended bus names, as established by the bus input program option setting (refer to Saved Case Specific Option Settings of the PSSE Program Operation Manual), are required and may be entered directly in the input fields. Alternatively, [Select...] adjacent to each input field may be used to open the [Bus Selection] dialog (Figure 7-3) where the desired bus may be specified by double-clicking on an entry in the selection list; click [Filter] to open a [Bus Filter] dialog (Figure 7-4) to apply filtering criteria to limit the number of buses in the selection list. Click [Go] to complete the joining process.
7-6
The summary output shown in Figure 7-8 reports the load identifier change. Figure 7-10 shows the [Diagram] view of the retained bus 154 after bus 3008 is joined with it. The topological changes are shown on the diagram.
7-7
7-8
Figure 7-10. Revised Topology After Joining Buses 154 and 3008
Additional Information
PSSE Program Operation Manual, Section 5.14, Joining Buses PSSE Application Program Interface (API), Section 1.75, JOIN
7-9
The working case must contain a validly specified power flow case.
The bus sectionalizing activity SPLT enables the user to split a bus into two buses connected by a branch. The [Split Buses] dialog (Figure 7-11) requires identification of the bus to be split and the number of the new bus. The bus name and base voltage to be assigned to the new bus may also be specified. If omitted, the base voltage of the bus being split and a blank name are assigned to the new bus.
Figure 7-11. Split Buses Dialog The bus number or extended bus name, as established by the bus input program option setting (refer to Saved Case Specific Option Settings of the PSSE Program Operation Manual), may be entered in the input field. Alternatively, [Select...] may be used to open the [Bus Selection] dialog (Figure 7-3) where the desired bus may be specified by double-clicking on an entry in the selection list; click [Filter] to open a [Bus Filter] dialog (Figure 7-4) to apply filtering criteria to limit the number of buses in the selection list. Click [Go] to initiate the splitting process. The new bus is created along with a new jumper branch connecting the original and new buses. The [Reassign Branches and Equipment] dialog then opens and any displayed equipment items connected to the bus being split may be specified to be moved to the new bus. Figure 7-12 shows the display if bus 154 were selected to be split in the savnw.sav power flow case.
7-10
7-11
Using the savnw.sav power flow case, (see Figure 7-13) bus 3003 can be split and circuit 2 from bus 3005 reassigned to the new bus 3020.
7-12
Selection of the bus to be split, and the specification of the number, name and base voltage to be assigned to the new bus, is done in [Split Buses] (see Figure 7-14). After clicking [Go], [Reassign Branches and Equipment] displays the elements that can be selected to be moved to the new bus 3020. In the example, the option to move circuit 2 from bus 3005 to the new bus has been selected. Clicking [OK] completes the process and generates a summary of the action in the Progress tab (Figure 7-15).
Figure 7-15. Example of Split Buses Output The result of the splitting process can be seen in [Diagram] (see Figure 7-16). The diagram shows the new bus, 3020, the new branch from the new bus to the original bus and the new routing of circuit 2 from bus 3005 to the new bus.
Figure 7-16. Diagram View of New Topology following Bus Split A one-line Slider file conforming to the original topology will now show circuit 2 out-of-service. A modified Slider file would have to be generated to display the new topology.
7-13
Additional Information
PSSE Program Operation Manual, Section 5.15, Splitting Buses PSSE Application Program Interface (API) Section 1.229, SPLT Section 1.105, MOVE3WND Section 1.106, MOVEBRN Section 1.107, MOVELOAD Section 1.108, MOVELOADS Section 1.109, MOVEMAC Section 1.110, MOVEPLNT Section 1.111, MOVESHUNT Section 1.112, MOVESHUNTS Section 1.113, MOVESWS
7-14
The working case must contain a validly specified power flow case.
The line tapping activity LTAP enables the user to introduce a new bus into the working case at a designated location along a specified ac branch. Any non-transformer branch may be tapped with activity LTAP. The [Tap Line] dialog (Figure 7-17) requires the user to specify the line to be tapped, the location of the new bus, and the identifying number, name, and base voltage of the new bus.
Figure 7-17. Tap Line Dialog As an example, the branch from bus 3003 to 3005 circuit 1 in the savnw.sav power flow case will be tapped at a point 40% of the distance from bus 3003. A new bus will be created with the number 3020, a name NEWBUS and a base voltage of 230 kV. Figure 7-18 shows the original topology as [Diagram].
7-15
Figure 7-18. Line Selected to be Tapped Click [Select] in [Tap Line] to open the [Branch Selection] dialog (see Figure 7-19). Specifying a bus in the From bus list will create a list of the to buses and circiut identifiers of the non-transformer branches connected to that bus. Then specify an entry in the To bus list. If required, the [Filter] can be used to reduce the listed buses to those in a specified subsystem. In the example (Figure 7-19), the branch from bus 3003 to bus 3005, circuit 1, has been selected. Clicking [OK] will return to [Tap Line].
7-16
7-17
Figure 7-20. Final Stage in Tap Line Activity In [Tap Line], the tap position, 40% of the distance from bus 3003 and the new bus name, number and base voltage are specified as shown in Figure 7-20. Clicking [OK] completes the process and generates a summary of the action at the Progress device. At this point, any Slider diagram established for the original network topology will indicate that the tapped line is out-of-service. The one-line Slider diagram will need to be modified to show the new topology with the new bus. Figure 7-21 shows a modified [Diagram] of the new topology around the new bus.
7-18
Additional Information
PSSE Program Operation Manual, Section 5.16, Tapping a Line PSSE Application Program Interface (API), Section 1.84, LTAP
7-19
The working case must contain a validly specified power flow case. PSSE permits the user to change the alphanumeric identifiers assigned to specified machines, loads, fixed bus shunts, ac branches, multi-section line groupings, dc lines, FACTS devices, and interarea transfers in the working case. In the GUI, the primary means of changing individual data items is the [Spreadsheet] (refer to Spreadsheet View).
Additional Information
PSSE Program Operation Manual, Section 5.17, Changing Equipment Identifiers PSSE Application Program Interface (API) Section 1.92, MBID2DC Section 1.93, MBID3WND Section 1.94, MBIDATRN Section 1.95, MBIDBRN Section 1.96, MBIDFACTS Section 1.97, MBIDLOAD Section 1.98, MBIDMAC Section 1.99, MBIDMDC Section 1.100, MBIDMSL Section 1.101, MBIDSHUNT Section 1.102, MBIDVSC
7-20
The working case must contain a validly specified power flow case.
The equipment transfer activity MOVE allows the user to move specified fixed shunts, switched shunts, loads, machines, and plants from one bus to another. It also provides for connecting the far end of specified branches and one winding of a three-winding transformer to different to buses. The [Move Network Elements] dialog (Figure 7-23) provides tabs for each of the types of equipment that may be moved by activity MOVE.
Figure 7-23. Move Network Elements Dialog Select the equipment category tab, and then specify the individual equipment to be moved and the bus to which the equipment item is to be transferred. Clicking [Apply] completes the transfer. Using the savnw.sav power flow case, the 500 kV line from bus 151, which terminates at bus 201 will be moved to terminate at bus 202. The original topology is shown in Figure 7-24.
7-21
Figure 7-24. Original Topology before Moving Branch 151 - 201 From the Branch tab on [Move Network Elements] click [Select...] to open the [Branch Selection] dialog (Figure 7-27) and highlight the desired branch. [Filter] may be used to limit the number of entries in the From bus list. Clicking [OK] returns to [Move Network Elements] where the new to bus can be specified.
7-22
Figure 7-25. Branch Selection Dialog From the Destination (to bus) area of the Branch tab on [Move Network Elements], the bus number or extended bus name, as established by the bus input program option setting (refer to Saved Case Specific Option Settings of the PSSE Program Operation Manual), may be entered in the bus input field. Alternatively, [Select...] may be used to open the [Bus Selection] dialog (Figure 7-3) where the desired bus may be specified by double-clicking on an entry in the selection list; click [Filter] to open a [Bus Filter] dialog (Figure 7-4) to apply filtering criteria to limit the number of buses in the selection list. Clicking [OK] in [Bus Selection] returns to [Move Network Elements] where all fields are now populated (Figure 7-27).
7-23
Figure 7-27. Example of Moving a Branch Click [Apply] to complete the move. To end activity MOVE, click [Close]. When the moving process is complete, the original one-line Slider file will not be able to display the new topology. The branch that was moved (in the case of this example, the line from bus 151 to bus 201) will be indicated as out-of-service. The Slider file will need to be modified to display the new line termination. Figure 7-28 shows the new display with the new line location and the indicated line out-of-service from the original topology. The non-existent branch can be deleted from the Slider file. It will no longer be in the network data and will not appear in [Spreadsheet] or [Network Tree].
7-24
Additional Information
PSSE Program Operation Manual, Section 5.18, Moving Equipment PSSE Application Program Interface (API) Section 1.105, MOVE3WND Section 1.106, MOVEBRN Section 1.107, MOVELOAD Section 1.108, MOVELOADS Section 1.109, MOVEMAC Section 1.110, MOVEPLNT Section 1.111, MOVESHUNT Section 1.112, MOVESHUNTS Section 1.113, MOVESWS See also: Section 3.6.9, Moving Diagram Elements
7-25
The working case must contain a validly specified power flow case.
PSSE facilitates the users ability to delete equipment items from the working case. In the GUI, the primary means of deleting individual equipment items is the [Spreadsheet] (refer to Chapter 2 Spreadsheet View). In addition, the following may be removed from a specified subsystem: subsystem buses and all equipment connected to them. all outaged items of a selected equipment category in a subsystem.
The [Delete Buses and Outaged Network Elements] dialog (Figure 7-29) enables the user to designate for processing either the entire working case or a specified bus subsystem (refer to Section 4.8, Subsystem Selection of the PSSE Program Operation Manual). A bus subsystem may be specified either via a [Bus Subsystem Selector] dialog by clicking [Select...], or by entering buses directly in the [Delete Buses and Outaged Network Elements] dialog
7-26
Figure 7-30. Example of Deleted Buses and the Diagram Properties Options
7-27
Additional Information
PSSE Program Operation Manual, Section 5.12, Removing Specified Buses and Connected Equipment Section 5.13, Deleting Equipment PSSE Application Program Interface (API) Section 1.55, EXTR Section 1.153, PURG See also: Section 3.6.3, Editing Functions Section 3.6.4, Binding Data
7-28
The working case must contain a validly specified power flow case. If generation is to be scaled, and a Type 3 bus is in the subsystem being scaled, the working case must be solved to an acceptable mismatch level.
Power Flow > Changing > Scale generation, load, shunt (SCAL)
The load, generation and shunt scaling activity SCAL enables the user to uniformly increase or decrease any or all of the following quantities for a specified grouping of loads, fixed shunts, and machines: Load active power. Load reactive power. Active component of fixed bus shunt admittance. Positive reactive component of fixed bus shunt admittance (capacitors). Negative reactive component of fixed bus shunt admittance (reactors). Generator active power output (positive generation). Motor active power output (negative generation).
The [Scale Powerflow Data] dialog (Figure 7-32) enables the user to designate for scaling either the entire working case or a specified bus subsystem (refer to Section 4.8, Subsystem Selection of the PSSE Program Operation Manual). A bus subsystem may be specified either via a [Bus Subsystem Selector] dialog by clicking [Select...], or by entering buses directly in the [Scale Powerflow Data] dialog.
7-29
Click [Go] to open a second [Scale Power Flow Data] dialog (Figure 7-33) where scaling targets for the data categories to be scaled may be specified.
7-30
Additional Information
PSSE ProgramProgram Operation Manual, Section 5.9, Scaling Loads, Generators, and/or Shunts PSSE Application Program Interface (API), Section 1.211, SCAL
7-31
The working case must contain a validly specified power flow case.
Power Flow > Changing > Transformer adjustment flags (TFLG)
The transformer adjustment enable flag setting activity TFLG allows the user to either enable or disable the adjustment status of all automatically adjustable transformer windings contained in the subsystem specified by the user. The [Transformer Adjustment Flags] dialog (Figure 7-35) enables the user to designate for processing either the entire working case or a specified bus subsystem (refer to Section 4.8, Subsystem Selection of the PSSE Program Operation Manual). A bus subsystem may be specified either via a [Bus Subsystem Selector] dialog by clicking [Select...], or by entering buses directly in the [Transformer Adjustment Flags] dialog. The setting to be assigned to the adjustment enable flags of automatically adjustable transformer windings contained in the specified subsystem is specified via the Allow automatic adjustment checkbox.
Additional Information
PSSE Program Operation Manual, Section 5.30, Changing Adjustment Enable Flags of Transformers PSSE Application Program Interface (API), Section 1.239, TFLG
7-32
The file selection window lists only Files of type: Economic Dispatch Data file (*.ecd). Highlight the desired file and click [Open]. The economic dispatch data is read into the working case.
Additional Information
PSSE Program Operation Manual, Section 5.31.1, Economic Dispatch Data File Contents
7-33
Power Flow Data Modification Performing Unit Commitment and Economic Dispatch
The working case must contain a validly specified power flow case. Economic Dispatch Data File (*.ecd)
Power Flow > Changing > Economic dispatch (ECDI)
The unit commitment/economic dispatch activity ECDI places machines in a specified subsystem in- or out-of-service to satisfy a given subsystem minimum capacity. The in-service machines in the subsystem are then dispatched on the basis of equal incremental cost to meet a specified total subsystem generation. On the [Economic Dispatch] dialog (Figure 7-36), the initial commitment option (develop a new commitment profile or start from the current commitment profile) is specified via the New commitment profile checkbox. The Economic Dispatch Data file may be specified either via a file selector dialog by clicking [...] next to the input field, or by entering its name directly in the input field. The [Economic Dispatch] dialog enables the user to designate for processing either the entire working case or a specified bus subsystem (refer to Section 4.8, Subsystem Selection of the PSS E Program Operation Manual). A bus subsystem may be specified either via a [Bus Subsystem Selector] dialog by clicking [Select...], or by entering buses directly in the [Economic Dispatch] dialog.
Figure 7-36. Economic Dispatch Dialog Click [Go] to start activity ECDI. When it completes its initial processing, activity ECDI summarizes the pre-dispatch conditions and brings up the [Dispatch Parameters] dialog (for example, Figure 7-37). Ater specifying the dispatch parameters, click [OK] to run the unit commitment and economic dispatch calculation.
7-34
Power Flow Data Modification Performing Unit Commitment and Economic Dispatch
Additional Information
PSSE Program Operation Manual, Section 5.31, Performing Unit Commitment and Economic Dispatch PSSE Application Program Interface (API), Section 1.50, ECDI
7-35
The working case must contain a validly specified power flow case.
Power Flow > Renumbering Areas / Owners / Zones
The area renumbering activity ARNM reassigns buses and/or loads in the working case from their original areas to a designated area. All buses and/or loads in the working case may be reassigned to a designated area; more typically, buses and/or loads in a specified subsystem of the working case are assigned to a designated area. To change area assignments, select the Area assignments tab of the [Renumbering Areas / Owners / Zones] dialog (Figure 7-38). The [Renumbering Areas / Owners / Zones] dialog enables the user to designate for area renumbering either the entire working case or a specified bus subsystem (refer to Section 4.8, Subsystem Selection of the PSSE Program Operation Manual). A bus subsystem may be specified either via a [Bus Subsystem Selector] dialog by clicking [Select...], or by entering buses directly in the [Renumbering Areas / Owners / Zones] dialog Use the Reassign radio button to indicate if only buses, only loads, or both buses and loads in the designated subsystem are to have their area assignments changed. Select the area to which subsystem buses and/or loads are to be assigned by highlighting an entry in either the Used areas scrolled list or the Unused areas scrolled list. Click [OK] or [Apply] to implement the area reassignments; a summary is printed at the Progress device. When [OK] is used, the [Renumbering Areas / Owners / Zones] dialog is dismissed; when [Apply] is used, the dialog remains and additional renumbering may be implemented.
7-36
Additional Information
PSSE Program Operation Manual: Section 5.20, Changing Area Assignments Areas, Zones and Owners
7-37
The working case must contain a validly specified power flow case.
Power Flow > Renumbering Areas / Owners / Zones
The owner renumbering activity OWNM reassigns buses, loads, machines, branches, FACTS devices and/or VSC dc lines in the working case from their original owners to a designated owner. All elements of the selected equipment types in the working case may be reassigned to a designated owner; more typically, all elements of the selected equipment types in a specified subsystem of the working case are assigned to a designated owner. To change owner assignments, select the Owner assignments tab of the [Renumbering Areas / Owners / Zones] dialog (Figure 7-39). The [Renumbering Areas / Owners / Zones] dialog enables the user to designate for owner renumbering either the entire working case or a specified bus subsystem (refer to Section 4.8, Subsystem Selection of the PSSE Program Operation Manual). A bus subsystem may be specified either via a [Bus Subsystem Selector] dialog by clicking [Select...], or by entering buses directly in the [Renumbering Areas / Owners / Zones] dialog. Use the Reassign check boxes to indicate one or more of the following equipment types for which elements in the designated subsystem are to have their owner assignments changed:
Buses Loads Machines Branches (non-transformers branches and transformers) FACTS devices VSC dc lines
When one or more of branches, FACTS devices, and VSC dc lines have been selected, the Branch reassignment options pull-down list is used to select for owner reassignment of series elements either: Subsystem branches only Subsystem tie lines only Subsystem branches and tie lines
Select the owner to which subsystem elements are to be assigned by highlighting an entry in either the Used owners scrolled list or the Unused owners scrolled list. Click [OK] or [Apply] to implement the owner reassignments; a summary is printed at the Progress device. When [OK] is used, the [Renumbering Areas / Owners / Zones] dialog is dismissed; when [Apply] is used, the dialog remains and additional renumbering may be implemented.
7-38
Additional Information
PSSE Program Operation Manual: Section 5.21, Changing Owner Assignments Areas, Zones and Owners
7-39
The working case must contain a validly specified power flow case.
Power Flow > Renumbering Areas / Owners / Zones
The zone renumbering activity ZONM reassigns buses and/or loads in the working case from their original zones to a designated zone. All buses and/or loads in the working case may be reassigned to a designated zone; more typically, buses and/or loads in a specified subsystem of the working case are assigned to a designated zone. To change zone assignments, select the Zone assignments tab of the [Renumbering Areas / Owners / Zones] dialog (Figure 7-40). The [Renumbering Areas / Owners / Zones] dialog enables the user to designate for zone renumbering either the entire working case or a specified bus subsystem (refer to Section 4.8, Subsystem Selection of the PSSE Program Operation Manual). A bus subsystem may be specified either via a [Bus Subsystem Selector] dialog by clicking [Select...], or by entering buses directly in the [Renumbering Areas / Owners / Zones] dialog Use the Reassign radio button to indicate if only buses, only loads, or both buses and loads in the designated subsystem are to have their zone assignments changed. Select the zone to which subsystem buses and/or loads are to be assigned by highlighting an entry in either the Used zones scrolled list or the Unused zones scrolled list.
7-40
Figure 7-40. Renumbering Areas/Owners/Zones Dialog: Zone Assignments Tab Click [OK] or [Apply] to implement the zone reassignments; a summary is printed at the Progress device. When [OK] is used, the [Renumbering Areas / Owners / Zones] dialog is dismissed; when [Apply] is used, the dialog remains and additional renumbering may be implemented.
7-41
Additional Information
PSSE Program Operation Manual: Section 5.22, Changing Zone Assignments Areas, Zones and Owners
7-42
The bus renumbering activity BSNM enables the user to change the bus numbers of specified network buses in the working case and retain a tabulation, normally in file form, of the bus number changes made. Access to the various bus renumbering methods available in activity BSNM is supplied by four dialogs corresponding to four menu entries available in the GUI. The option for the handling of the output tabulation records produced by activity BSNM is specified in the Select output destination area on each BSNM dialog. The following options are available: Click the Data file radio button on the dialog to preserve the output tabulation records in a Bus Renumbering Translation File. The name of the Bus Renumbering Translation File may be specified either via a file selector dialog by clicking [...] next to the input field, or by entering its name directly in the input field next to the Data file radio button. Click the Report window radio button on the dialog to write the output tabulation records to the Report device. Click the No output radio button on the dialog to suppress the writing of the output tabulation records.
The [Renumber Buses by Bus Number] dialog (Figure 7-42) is used to renumber buses using the bus number to bus number translation method. See Section 7.16, Renumbering Buses for a description of the Select output destination area.
7-43
File Input
If bus number pairs are to be supplied in a Bus Renumbering Translation File, its name is specified in the Bus translation file field. The name of the file may be specified either via a file selector dialog by clicking [...] next to the input field, or by entering its name directly in the input field. Then click [Go] to complete the renumbering process and dismiss the dialog.
Dialog Input
If bus number pairs are to be specified on the dialog, the old and new bus numbers are entered in the Old bus number and New bus number fields, respectively. The old bus number may be entered directly in the Old bus number input field. Alternatively, [Select...] adjacent to the input field may be used to open the [Bus Selection] dialog (Figure 7-3) where the desired bus may be specified by double-clicking on an entry in the selection list; click [Filter] to open a [Bus Filter] dialog (Figure 7-4) to apply filtering criteria to limit the number of buses in the selection list. Click [Go] to implement the specified bus number change. The dialog remains and another bus number pair may be specified, or click [Close] to end activity BSNM.
7-44
The [Renumber Buses by Bus Name] dialog (Figure 7-43) is used to renumber buses using the bus name to bus number translation method. See Section 7.16, Renumbering Buses for a description of the Select output destination area.
File Input
If bus name, number pairs are to be supplied in an input data file, its name is specified in the Bus translation file field. The name of the file may be specified either via a file selector dialog by clicking [...] next to the input field, or by entering its name directly in the input field. Then click [Go] to complete the renumbering process and dismiss the dialog.
Dialog Input
If bus name, number pairs are to be specified on the dialog, the extended bus name and new bus number are entered in the Old bus name and New bus number fields, respectively. The old bus name may be entered directly in the Old bus name input field. Alternatively, [Select...] adjacent to the input field may be used to open the [Bus Selection] dialog (Figure 7-3) where the desired bus may be specified by double-clicking on an entry in the selection list; click [Filter] to open a [Bus Filter] dialog (Figure 7-4) to apply filtering criteria to limit the number of buses in the selection list. Click [Go] to implement the specified bus number change. The dialog remains and another bus name, number pair may be specified, or click [Close] to end activity BSNM.
7-45
The [Renumber Buses by Bus Packing] dialog (Figure 7-44) is used to renumber buses using the bus number packing translation method. See Section 7.16, Renumbering Buses for a description of the Select output destination area.
Figure 7-44. Renumber Buses by Bus Packing Dialog The numbers defining the bus number range are entered in the Pack starting bus number and Pack ending bus number fields. Click [Go] to implement the packing of bus numbers in the specified range into the low end of the range. The dialog remains and another bus range may be specified, or click [Close] to end activity BSNM.
7-46
The [Renumber Buses by Subsystem] dialog (Figure 7-45) is used to renumber buses using any of the following bus renumbering methods: All buses without area blocking method. All buses with area blocking method. Subsystem bus number range method. Subsystem bus number offset method.
See Section 7.16, Renumbering Buses for a description of the Select output destination area.
7-47
Then click [Go] to complete the renumbering process and dismiss the dialog.
Then click [Go] to open the [Block Numbers By Area] dialog (see Figure 7-46).
Figure 7-46. Example of Block Numbers By Area Dialog The [Block Numbers By Area] dialog contains an entry for each area in the working case that has at least one bus assigned to it. Specify a new bus number range for each area on the dialog.Then click [Go] to complete the renumbering process and dismiss the dialog. No bus number changes are implemented until new number ranges are specified for all areas shown on the dialog. Consequently, unless non-zero bus numbers are entered to indicate the bus number ranges for each area on the dialog, the renumbering process will not be initiated.
Click [Go] to implement the specified subsystem renumbering. The dialog remains and another bus subsystem may be renumbered, or click [Close] to end activity BSNM.
7-48
Click [Go] to implement the specified subsystem renumbering. The dialog remains and another bus subsystem may be renumbered, or click [Close] to end activity BSNM.
Additional Information
7-49
The working case must contain a validly specified power flow case. A Bus Renumbering Translation File must be available.
File > Renumber buses in auxiliary files (RNFI)
The auxiliary data input file bus renumbering activity RNFI reflects changes in bus numbering in auxiliary data input files. It is used primarily in conjunction with activity BSNM to coordinate bus renumbering implemented in a Saved Case with auxiliary data input files associated with the Saved Case and read by other PSSE activities. The [Renumber Buses in Auxiliary Files] dialog (Figure 7-47) is available only when using [Spreadsheet].
Figure 7-47. Renumber Buses in Auxiliary Files Dialog First, select the type of file to be processed from the Auxiliary data file type pull-down list. An abbreviation for the activity that requires the file type appears in parentheses, as follows: Sequence data (RESQ) Dynamics data (DYRE) Machine impedance data (MCRE) Dispatch data (ECDI) Dispatch data (INLF) Breaker duty data (BKDY) Fault specification data (BKDY) Fault control data (ASCC) Capability curve data (GCAP) Load throwover data (ACCC) Fault specification data (ANSI) Subsystem description data (ACCC) Monitored element data (ACCC) Contingency description data (ACCC) Tripping data (ACCC)
7-50
Then specify the files to be used by activity RNFI. Bus Number Translation file (*.trn) Auxiliary Data file (files corresponding to Auxiliary data file type) Output data file (files corresponding to Auxiliary data file type)
For each of these files, its name may be typed directly in its input field, or you can click [...] next to the input field to specify the name of the file from a file selector dialog.
Additional Information
PSSE Program Operation Manual, Section 5.19, Renumbering Buses in Auxiliary Files Section 5.45, Bus Renumbering PSSE Application Program Interface (API), Section 1.204, RNFI
7-51
The working case must contain a validly specified power flow case. Sequence data must be present in the working case. PSSE permits the user to change all sequence data associated with equipment represented in the working case. In the GUI, the primary means of changing individual data items is the [Spreadsheet] (refer to Spreadsheet View).
Additional Information
PSSE Program Operation Manual: Section 5.25, Changing Sequence Data See also: Section 7.1, Changing Service Status and Power Flow Parametric Data
7-52
7-53
7-54
Chapter 8
Data Reports
8.1 Working Case Data Reporting
PSSE facilitates the listing of all data in the working case for viewing, problem checking, or case documentation. Through the [List Data] dialog (Figure 8-1), the following tabulations of working case data can be produced: Categories of power flow data in tabular form (activity LIST). Power flow data grouped together on a bus-by-bus basis (activity EXAM). Categories of sequence data (i.e., fault analysis data) in tabular form (activity SQLI). Sequence data grouped together on a bus-by-bus basis (activity SQEX). Categories of optimal power flow data in tabular form (activity LSTO). Outaged network elements (activity OUTS). Fixed and/or switched bus shunts (activity SHNT). Extended bus names in alphabetic order (activity ALPH).
Click the radio button on the [List Data] dialog corresponding to the desired reporting function. If the selected function has provision for reporting options, the corresponding controls on the dialog are enabled. The [List Data] dialog enables the user to designate for processing either the entire working case or a specified bus subsystem (refer to Section 4.8, Subsystem Selection of the PSSE Program Operation Manual). A bus subsystem may be specified either via a [Bus Subsystem Selector] dialog by clicking [Select...], or by entering buses directly in the [List Data] dialog. Reports are routed to the Report device.
8-1
8-2
The data listing activity LIST tabulates the power flow working case in a form suitable for problem data documentation. The report generated by activity LIST is separated into several categories of data. Activity LIST is accessible from the Powerflow radio button of the [List Data] dialog (Figure 8-1). The data category to be tabulated is selected from the drop down list next to the Powerflow radio button on the dialog. The Output voltage radio buttons provide for the tabulation of ac voltages in either per unit or kilovolts. The Use double entry branch method check box is used to select either single or double entry format for branch related category reports when either the All data or Branches report is specified in the drop down list. The [List Data] dialog enables the user to designate for processing either the entire working case or a specified bus subsystem (refer to Section 4.8, Subsystem Selection of the PSSE Program Operation Manual). A bus subsystem may be specified either via a [Bus Subsystem Selector] dialog by clicking [Select...], or by entering buses directly in the [List Data] dialog.
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
8-3
The bus alphabetic listing activity ALPH prints an alphabetically sorted table of all buses in a specified subsystem of the working case. Activity ALPH is accessible from the Bus names radio button of the [List Data] dialog (Figure 8-1). The [List Data] dialog enables the user to designate for processing either the entire working case or a specified bus subsystem (refer to Section 4.8, Subsystem Selection of the PSSE Program Operation Manual). A bus subsystem may be specified either via a [Bus Subsystem Selector] dialog by clicking [Select...], or by entering buses directly in the [List Data] dialog.
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
8-4
The data examination activity EXAM produces a tabulation of power flow data organized by bus. For each bus tabulated, its bus data is followed by the data associated with each network element that is connected to the bus. Activity EXAM is accessible from the Examine Powerflow / sequence data radio button of the [List Data] dialog (Figure 8-1). The sequence data check box must be unchecked. The [List Data] dialog enables the user to designate for processing either the entire working case or a specified bus subsystem (refer to Section 4.8, Subsystem Selection of the PSSE Program Operation Manual). A bus subsystem may be specified either via a [Bus Subsystem Selector] dialog by clicking [Select...], or by entering buses directly in the [List Data] dialog.
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
8-5
The sequence data listing activity SQLI tabulates the sequence data arrays in the working case in a form suitable for problem data documentation. The report generated by activity SQLI is separated into several categories of data.. Activity SQLI is accessible from the Sequence data radio button of the [List Data] dialog (Figure 81). The data category to be tabulated is selected from the drop down list next to the Sequence data radio button on the dialog. The [List Data] dialog enables the user to designate for processing either the entire working case or a specified bus subsystem (refer to Section 4.8, Subsystem Selection of the PSSE Program Operation Manual). A bus subsystem may be specified either via a [Bus Subsystem Selector] dialog by clicking [Select...], or by entering buses directly in the [List Data] dialog.
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
8-6
8.1.5 Listing Sequence Data for Buses and their Connected Equipment
Activity SQEX
Requirements / Prerequisites The working case must contain a validly specified power flow case with sequence data appended to it..
The sequence data examination activity SQEX produces a tabulation of fault analysis data organized by bus. For each bus tabulated, its shunt load data is followed by the data associated with each network element that is connected to the bus for which sequence data is applicable. Activity SQEX is accessible from the Examine Powerflow / sequence data radio button of the [List Data] dialog (Figure 8-1). The Sequence data check box must be checked. The [List Data] dialog enables the user to designate for processing either the entire working case or a specified bus subsystem (refer to Section 4.8, Subsystem Selection of the PSSE Program Operation Manual). A bus subsystem may be specified either via a [Bus Subsystem Selector] dialog by clicking [Select...], or by entering buses directly in the [List Data] dialog.
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
8-7
The outaged equipment reporting activity OUTS tabulates those components in the working case that are removed from service. Activity OUTS is accessible from the Outaged equipment radio button of the [List Data] dialog (Figure 8-1). The [List Data] dialog enables the user to designate for processing either the entire working case or a specified bus subsystem (refer to Section 4.8, Subsystem Selection of the PSSE Program Operation Manual). A bus subsystem may be specified either via a [Bus Subsystem Selector] dialog by clicking [Select...], or by entering buses directly in the [List Data] dialog.
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
8-8
The bus shunt summary activity SHNT tabulates fixed and/or switched bus shunts contained in the working case. Activity SHNT is accessible from the Bus shunts radio button of the [List Data] dialog (Figure 8-1). The type(s) of bus shunts to be tabulated is selected from the Report drop down list below the Bus shunts radio button on the dialog. The [List Data] dialog enables the user to designate for processing either the entire working case or a specified bus subsystem (refer to Section 4.8, Subsystem Selection of the PSSE Program Operation Manual). A bus subsystem may be specified either via a [Bus Subsystem Selector] dialog by clicking [Select...], or by entering buses directly in the [List Data] dialog.
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
8-9
Figure 8-2. File Information Dialog Three reports are available from the [File Information] dialog: System Components Saved Case and Snapshot Filenames Unused Bus Numbers
8-10
The case size summary activity SIZE tabulates the number of components in the working case, along with the maximum number permitted at the current size level of PSSE working memory. Activity SIZE is accessible from the List the number of system components radio button of the [File Information] dialog.
Section 5.33.3, Editing the Two-Line Case Title or the Long Title
PSSE Application Program Interface (API), Section 1.225, SIZE
8-11
8-12
The unused bus number summary activity BUSN tabulates those numbers, from within a user specified bus number range, which are not assigned to buses in the working case. Activity BUSN is accessible from the List unused bus numbers in a range radio button of the [File Information] dialog. The bus number range is specified in the Starting bus and Ending bus input fields on the dialog.
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
8-13
8-14
Chapter 9
Case Comparison
9.1 Comparing Power Flow Case Totals
Activity CMPR
Requirements / Prerequisites Validly specified power flow case.
If losses, mismatches, or interchange are to be compared, both cases should be solved to an acceptable mismatch level. Saved Case file (*.sav) File > Compare
The [Compare Case Totals] dialog (Figure 9-1) creates a report comparing working case totals by area, owner, or zone with a specified saved case. Click [ ] to open the selection window for the required Saved Case file (*.sav). Click [Go] to perform the activity. The comparison is routed to the Report tab by default (Figure 9-2). You will need to click [Close] to end this activity.
9-1
9-2
The [Compare Powerflow Cases] dialog (Figure 9-3) creates a report comparing a specified bus subsystem quantity in the working case with a saved case. Click [ ] to open the selection window for the required Saved Case file (*.sav).
9-3
Click [Go] to open the [Select Powerflow Comparison Options] dialog (Figure 9-4).
Figure 9-4. Select Powerflow Comparison Options Dialog The dialog activates comparison threshold values, load characteristics, or ratings appropriate to the specification of one of the following quantities:
Bus identifiers Bus type codes Machine status Generator MW Generator MW or MVAR Bus loads Bus shunts Switched shunts Voltage Voltage and angle MBASE & ZSORCE MBASE & ZPOS MBASE & ZNEG MBASE & ZZERO Negative sequence bus shunts Zero sequence bus shunts Branch status Line R, X, B Line shunts Line ratings Metered end Transformers Flows MW or MVAR (from bus) Flows MW or MVAR (from & to) Line MW or MVAR losses Zero sequence R, X, B Zero sequence line shunts Connection codes Zero sequence mutuals Multi-section lines Multi-section line metered end Bus load status Line lengths Generator MVAR Flows MW (from bus) Flows MVAR (from bus) Flows MW (from & to) Flows MVAR (from & to) Line MW losses Line MVAR losses Fixed shunt status Switched shunt status
Bus load characteristics that may be compared include one of the following quantities:
Total nominal load Constant MVA Constant current Constant admittance
9-4
Click [Compare] to perform the activity. The comparison is routed to the Report tab by default (Figure 9-5). You will need to click [Close] to end this activity.
9-5
The [Compare Tie Lines] dialog (Figure 9-6) creates a report comparing a specified tie line quantity in the working case with a specified saved case. Click [ ] to open the selection window for the required Saved Case file (*.sav).
9-6
Click [Go] to open the [Select Tie Line Comparison Options] dialog (Figure 9-7).
Figure 9-7. Select Tie Line Comparison Options Dialog The dialog activates comparison threshold values or ratings appropriate to the specification of one of the following quantities:
Branch status Line R, X, B Line shunts Line ratings Metered end Line length Transformers Flows MW or MVAR (from bus) Flows MW or MVAR (from & to) Line MW or MVAR losses Zero sequence R, X, B Zero sequence line shunts Connection codes Flow MW (from bus) Flow MVAR (from bus) Flow MW (from & to) Flow MVAR (from & to) Line MW losses Line MVAR losses
Click [Compare] to perform the activity. The comparison is routed to the Report tab by default You will need to click [Close] to end this activity.
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
9-7
9-8
Chapter 10
Creating Power Flow Data Files
10.1 Creating a Saved Case File
Activity SAVE
Requirements / Prerequisites The working case must contain a validly specified power flow case.
The case saving activity SAVE stores the working case into a user-specified Saved Case file in a compressed format. Activity SAVE is accessible from the Case Data tab of the [Save Network Data] dialog (Figure 101). The Saved Case File may be specified either via a file selector dialog by clicking [...] next to the input field, or by entering its name directly in the input field. Click [OK] to save the working case in the designated file.
10-1
10-2
Creating Power Flow Data Files Saving the Working Case in an IEEE Common Format File
The IEEE Common Format output activity RWCM writes the working case as a file in IEEE common tape format data records. Activity RWCM is accessible from the IEEE Format Power Flow Data tab of the [Save Network Data] dialog (Figure 10-2). To write the data records to a file, select the Data file radio button in the Destination area of the dialog. The name of the file may be specified either via a file selector dialog by clicking [...] next to the input field, or by entering its name directly in the input field. To write the data records to the Report device, select the Report window radio button in the Destination area of the dialog. To ignore dc lines and FACTS devices in the data records, uncheck the Add power to loads checkbox; to represent their power injections as load, check the Add power to loads checkbox. Click [OK] to save the working case in the designated file in the IEEE format.
10-3
Creating Power Flow Data Files Saving the Working Case in an IEEE Common Format File
Section 5.46, Saving the Working Case in an IEEE Common Format File
PSSE Application Program Interface (API),
10-4
The machine impedance data output activity RWMA writes out machine parametric data from the working case in the form of a Machine Impedance Data File. Activity RWMA is accessible from the Machine Impedance Data tab of the [Save Network Data] dialog (Figure 10-3). To write the data records to a file, select the Data file radio button in the Destination area of the dialog. The name of the file may be specified either via a file selector dialog by clicking [...] next to the input field, or by entering its name directly in the input field. To write the data records to the Report device, select the Report window radio button in the Destination area of the dialog. To exclude data data records for out-of-service machines, uncheck the Include records for out-ofservice machines checkbox; to include them, check the Include records for out-of-service machines checkbox. Designate the quantities to be used in calculating the active and reactive power split fractions by selecting the appropriate entries from the two drop-down lists in the Machine Impedance area of the dialog. The [Save Network Data] dialog enables the user to designate for processing either the entire working case or a specified bus subsystem (refer to Section 4.8, Subsystem Selection of the PSS E Program Operation Manual). A bus subsystem may be specified either via a [Bus Subsystem Selector] dialog by clicking [Select...], or by entering buses directly in the [Save Network Data] dialog. Click [OK] to save the machine parametric data in Machine Impedance Data File format.
10-5
10-6
Creating Power Flow Data Files Creating a Power Flow Raw Data File
The Raw Data File output activity RAWD writes the working case in the form of a Power Flow Raw Data File. That is, when directed to a file, the data records written by activity RAWD are in a format suitable for input to activity READ. Activity RAWD is accessible from the Power Flow Raw Data tab of the [Save Network Data] dialog (Figure 10-4). To write the data records to a file, select the Data file radio button in the Destination area of the dialog. The name of the file may be specified either via a file selector dialog by clicking [...] next to the input field, or by entering its name directly in the input field. To write the data records to the Report device, select the Report window radio button in the Destination area of the dialog. The user must designate the intended use of the Power Flow Raw Data File by selecting one of the following entries from the Configure RAW file to drop-down list: Initialize working case: suitable for use by activity READ with IC on the first data record set to 0 (default). Add to working case: suitable for use by activity READ with IC on the first data record set to 1. Use with RDCH: suitable for use by activity RDCH (i.e., the three case identification data records are omitted).
The [Save Network Data] dialog enables the user to designate for processing either the entire working case or a specified bus subsystem (refer to Section 4.8, Subsystem Selection of the PSS E Program Operation Manual). A bus subsystem may be specified either via a [Bus Subsystem Selector] dialog by clicking [Select...], or by entering buses directly in the [Save Network Data] dialog. If the All area ties radio button is selected, RAWD writes data records only for branches between areas. Options to be used in writing Power Flow Raw Data records are specified via checkboxes and a drop-down list in the Include area of the dialog. The checkboxes provide options to include network components: isolated buses, out of service branches, subsystem data, subsystem tie lines, and/or bus names. The drop-down list selects of one of the following load options: Include all loads at subsystem buses Include subsystem loads at all buses Include all loads at subsystem buses and subsystem loads at non-subsystem buses
10-7
Creating Power Flow Data Files Creating a Power Flow Raw Data File
Click [OK] to save the power flow data in Power Flow Raw Data File format.
Figure 10-4. Save Network Data Dialog, Power Flow Raw Data
Section 5.48, Creating a Power Flow Raw Data File Section 5.2.1, Power Flow Raw Data File Contents
PSSE Application Program Interface (API),
10-8
The Sequence Data File output activity RWSQ writes the sequence data contained in the working case in the form of a Sequence Data File. That is, when directed to a file, the data records written by activity RWSQ are in a format suitable for input to activity RESQ. Activity RWSQ is accessible from the Sequence Data tab of the [Save Network Data] dialog (Figure 10-5). To write the data records to a file, select the Data file radio button in the Destination area of the dialog. The name of the file may be specified either via a file selector dialog by clicking [...] next to the input field, or by entering its name directly in the input field. To write the data records to the Report device, select the Report window radio button in the Destination area of the dialog. The [Save Network Data] dialog enables the user to designate for processing either the entire working case or a specified bus subsystem (refer to Section 4.8, Subsystem Selection of the PSS E Program Operation Manual). A bus subsystem may be specified either via a [Bus Subsystem Selector] dialog by clicking [Select...], or by entering buses directly in the [Save Network Data] dialog. If the All area ties radio button is selected, RWSQ writes data records only for branches between areas. The various options to be used in writing the Sequence Data records are specified via checkboxes in the Include area of the dialog. Click [OK] to save the fault analysis data in Sequence Data File format.
10-9
Section 5.49, Creating a Sequence Data File Section 5.5.1, Sequence Data File Contents
PSSE Application Program Interface (API),
10-10
Creating Power Flow Data Files Creating a Transactions Raw Data File
The Transactions Raw Data File output activity RWMM writes the transactions data contained in working memory in the form of a Transactions Raw Data File. That is, when directed to a file, the data records written by activity RWMM are in a format suitable for input to activity REMM. Activity RWMM is accessible from the Transaction Data tab of the [Save Network Data] dialog (Figure 10-6). To write the data records to a file, select the Data file radio button in the Destination area of the dialog. The name of the file may be specified either via a file selector dialog by clicking [...] next to the input field, or by entering its name directly in the input field. To write the data records to the Report device, select the Report window radio button in the Destination area of the dialog. Click [OK] to save the transactions data in Transaction Raw Data File format.
10-11
Creating Power Flow Data Files Creating a Transactions Raw Data File
Section 5.50, Creating a Transactions Raw Data File Section 5.6.1, Transactions Raw Data File Contents
PSSE Application Program Interface (API),
10-12
Chapter 11
Power Flow Solutions
The Power Flow menu provides access to most of the PSSE steady-state analyses. Included are the power flow solutions for both ac and dc network analysis, data access and listing, network, dispatch, load and topology manipulations. Methods are available for checking network conditions and exporting results. Analysis methods provided in the power flow menu include the following: Decoupled Newton-Raphson Power Flow Solution (Section 11.2.1) Fully-Coupled Newton-Raphson Power Flow Solution (Section 11.2.2) Fixed Slope Decoupled Newton-Raphson Power Flow Solution (Section 11.2.3) Newton-Raphson Power Flow Solution with Inertial Governot Dispatch (Section 11.2.4) Gauss-Seidel Power Flow Solution (Section 11.2.5) AC Contingency Analysis (Section 11.3) Multi-Level Contingency Analysis (Section 11.5) Generation Dispatch (Section 11.6) PV Analysis (Section 11.7) QV Analysis (Section 11.8) Probabilistic Reliability Assessment (Section 11.9) Substation Reliability Assessment (Section 11.10)
Short-circuit analysis (Chapter 15), the Optimal Power Flow (Chapter 19), transmission access analysis (Chapter 18), and dynamic simulation and disturbances (Chapter 21) methods are available on separate menus.
11-1
The constant power characteristic holds the load power constant as long as the bus voltage exceeds the value specified by the modifiable parameter PQBRAK. The [Solution Parameters] dialog General tab provides access to this parameter. Notification of the change is routed to the Progress tab.
11-2
On the Gauss tab of [Solution Parameters], changes can be made to the acceleration factors, ACCP/ACCQ, and the TOL and ITMX parameters. The BLOWUP parameter is available on the General tab.
Load Data
11-3
On the Newton tab of [Solution Parameters], changes can be made to the the following: ACCN - the acceleration factor TOL - the largest mismatch in MW and Mvar ITMXN - the maximum number of iterations DVLIM - the largest change in bus voltage NDVFCT - the non-divergent improvement factor VCTOLQ - the controlled bus Q mismatch convergence tolerance VCTOLV - the controlled bus voltage error convergence tolerance
11-4
The three Newton-Raphson iterative algorithms solve for the bus voltages needed to satisfy the bus boundary conditions contained in the working case. The [Loadflow Solutions] dialog (Figure 114) provides options for all three Newton-Raphson solution methods. The toolbar button opens [Loadflow Solutions] or automatically executes the previously used solution method without opening the dialog. To re-open the dialog for each analysis, enable the option Show this window when using the Solve toolbar button. Newton-Raphson controls are modified using [Solution Parameters]. See Section 11.1.3. Automatic adjustments that allow maneuvering the system to meet specified voltage, branch flow, and area net interchange schedules are enabled or disabled using [Program Settings]. See Changing Program Settings. The user must specify Solution options for Tap adjustment, Switched shunt adjustments and Area interchange control; these options override automatic adjustments. Checkboxes to enable/disable Solution options for Flat start, Adjust phase shift, and Adjust DC taps are also available. VAR limits may also be specified to control the number of iterations during which generator reactive power limits will first be applied. Click [Solve] to process the working case. Solution output is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 115).
11-5
11-6
11-7
The three Newton-Raphson iterative algorithms solve for the bus voltages needed to satisfy the bus boundary conditions contained in the working case. The [Loadflow Solutions] dialog (Figure 116) provides options for all three Newton-Raphson solution methods. The toolbar button opens [Loadflow Solutions] or automatically executes the previously used solution method without opening the dialog. To re-open the dialog for each analysis, enable the option Show this window when using the Solve toolbar button. Newton-Raphson controls are modified using [Solution Parameters]. See Section 11.1.3. Automatic adjustments that allow maneuvering the system to meet specified voltage, branch flow, and area net interchange schedules are enabled or disabled using [Program Settings]. See Changing Program Settings. The user must specify Solution options for Tap adjustment, Switched shunt adjustments and Area interchange control; these options override automatic adjustments. Activity FNSL requires the prior execution of activity ORDR. If the need for a new bus ordering is detected, activity ORDR is automatically executed before beginning the voltage change calculation. Checkboxes to enable/disable Solution options for Flat start, Non-divergent solution, Adjust phase shift, and Adjust DC taps are also available. VAR limits may also be specified to control the number of iterations during which generator reactive power limits will first be applied. Click [Solve] to process the working case. Solution output is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 117).
11-8
11-9
11-10
The three Newton-Raphson iterative algorithms solve for the bus voltages needed to satisfy the bus boundary conditions contained in the working case. The [Loadflow Solutions] dialog (Figure 118) provides options for all three Newton-Raphson solution methods. The toolbar button opens [Loadflow Solutions] or automatically executes the previously used solution method without opening the dialog. To re-open the dialog for each analysis, enable the option Show this window when using the Solve toolbar button. Newton-Raphson controls are modified using [Solution Parameters]. See Section 11.1.3. Automatic adjustments that allow maneuvering the system to meet specified voltage, branch flow, and area net interchange schedules are enabled or disabled using [Program Settings]. See Changing Program Settings. The user must specify Solution options for Tap adjustment, Switched shunt adjustments and Area interchange control; these options override automatic adjustments. Checkboxes to enable/disable Solution options for Flat start, Non-divergent solution, Adjust phase shift, and Adjust DC taps are also available. VAR limits may also be specified to control the number of iterations during which generator reactive power limits will first be applied. Click [Solve] to process the working case. Solution output is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 119).
11-11
11-12
Section 6.7, Applying Fixed Slope Decoupled Newton-Raphson Power Flow Solution
11-13
Power Flow > Solution > N-R solution with inertial / governor dispatch (INLF)
The [N-R Solution with Inertial / Governor Redispatch] dialog requires specification of Solution options, Switched shunt adjustments, VAR limits, and the Solution type (Governor or Inertial). The Governor solution requires specification of Plimits from among the following options: Pre PSSE Rev-29 approach 0.0 to 1.0 for both types Working case values for both types
11-14
Figure 11-10. N-R Solution with Inertial / Governor Redispatch Dialog Click [ ] to open the selection window to save data in a Unit Inertia and Governor Data file (*.inl), which can be a new file or a previously-built file to be over-written. Area interchange control and the non-divergent solution option are always disabled in this solution. Click [Solve] to process the working case. Solution output is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 119). This activity modifies the data in the working case. If you wish to protect the original data, you must save the redispatch data with a different filename.
11-15
Section 6.8, Applying Newton-Raphson Power Flow Solution with Inertial / Governor Dispatch Section 6.8.1, Inertia and Governor Response Data File Contents
11-16
The Gauss-Seidel iterative algorithms solve for the bus voltages needed to satisfy the bus boundary conditions contained in the working case. The [Loadflow Solutions] dialog (Figure 11-12) provides options for either the Gauss-Seidel or Modified Gauss-Seidel solutions. The toolbar button opens [Loadflow Solutions] or automatically executes the previously used solution method without opening the dialog. To re-open the dialog for each analysis, enable the option Show this window when using the Solve toolbar button. Gauss-Seidel controls are modified using [Solution Parameters]. See Section 11.1.2. Automatic adjustments that allow maneuvering the system to meet specified voltage, branch flow, and area net interchange schedules are enabled or disabled using [Program Settings]. See Changing Program Settings. The user must specify Solution options for Switched shunt adjustments and Area interchange control; these options override automatic adjustments. Checkboxes to enable/disable Solution options for Flat start, Ignore Var limits, Adjust DC taps, and Adjust taps are also available. Click [Solve] to process the working case. Solution output is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 1113).
11-17
11-18
11-19
The Gauss-Seidel iterative algorithms solve for the bus voltages needed to satisfy the bus boundary conditions contained in the working case. The [Loadflow Solutions] dialog (Figure 11-14) provides options for either the Gauss-Seidel or Modified Gauss-Seidel solutions. The toolbar button opens [Loadflow Solutions] or automatically executes the previously used solution method without opening the dialog. To re-open the dialog for each analysis, enable the option Show this window when using the Solve toolbar button. Gauss-Seidel controls are modified using [Solution Parameters]. See Section 11.1.2. Automatic adjustments that allow maneuvering the system to meet specified voltage, branch flow, and area net interchange schedules are enabled or disabled using [Program Settings]. See Changing Program Settings. The user must specify Solution options for Switched shunt adjustments and Area interchange control; these options override automatic adjustments. Checkboxes to enable/disable Solution options for Flat start, Ignore Var limits, Adjust DC taps, and Adjust taps are also available. Click [Solve] to process the working case. Solution output is routed to the Progress tab.
11-20
11-21
Most work done with a power flow data base is investigative and linked to system performance under contingency conditions, usually N-1 (loss of any one element). The user can switch a network element out of service or modify element ratings (loads, shunts, element ratings, element impedances etc) by editing data cells in [Network Spreadsheet]. After the data change is made (status or value), the user can solve the revised power flow. The network contingency calculation function calculates full AC power flow solutions for a specified set of contingency cases. Results are stored in a binary file. This file is subsequently processed to produce reports of violations, loadings, and available capacity (for details, see Section 16.5, AC Contingency Reports). Since the information stored in the Distribution Factor Data File is a function of data organization and network topology in the working case, it follows that it must be re-executed with Calculate Distribution factors disabled before running an ac contingency analysis (see Section 13.1). To change defaults for the single line contingency ranking process, see Section 13.3, Estimating Severity Rankings for Single Line Outage Contingencies. Solution options and a Solution Engine must be specified. Click [ ] to open the selection window for the required Distribution factor data file (*.dfx). A filename for the Contingency solution output file (*.acc) is required; it can be a new file or a previously-built file to be over-written. If desired, an optional Load throwover data file (*.thr) may also be specified. If a dispatch mode is enabled, a Unit inertia and governor data file (*.inl) input file may be specified. Dispatch modes may be enabled for the following: Subsystem machines (Reserve) Subsystem machines (PMAX) Subsystem machines (Inertia) Subsystem machines (Governor droop)
Click [Solve]. A summary of the solution process is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 11-16).
11-22
11-23
11-24
Corrective actions are modeled as an optimal power flow problem. The objective function is to minimize the control adjustments needed to remove limit violations in the power system. The [AC Corrective Actions] dialog (Figure 11-18) provides Solution options, Constraint options, and Control options, as well as a filter and Mismatch tolerance setting to refine the solution. Click [ ] to open the selection window for the required Distribution factor data file (*.dfx). Click [Solve]. A summary of the solution process is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 11-17).
11-25
11-26
The [Multi-Level AC Contingency Solution] dialog (Figure 11-19) contains four tabs, Power Flow Control, Multiple Contingency Analysis, Tripping Simulation and Corrective Actions, each of which provides options for one function of the analysis. One or more of these functions may be specified for the multi-level solution.
Figure 11-19. Multi-Level AC Contingency Solution Dialog, Power Flow Control The Power Flow Control tab contains the same options that [AC Contingency Solution] provides (Figure 11-15). Solution options and a Solution Engine must be specified. Click [ ] to open the selection window for the required Distribution factor data file (*.dfx). A filename for the Contingency
11-27
solution output file (*.acc) is required; it can be a new file or a previously-built file to be over-written. If desired, an optional Load throwover data file (*.thr) may also be specified. If a dispatch mode is enabled, a Unit Inertia and Governor Data file (*.inl) input file may be specified. Dispatch modes may be enabled for the following: Subsystem machines (Reserve) Subsystem machines (PMAX) Subsystem machines (Inertia) Subsystem machines (Governor droop)
The Multiple Contingency Analysis tab, when its analysis is enabled, allows specification of levels of analysis and Ranking options that include enabling filters for Line overload, Machine overload, Voltage depression, and Islanding.
11-28
The Tripping Simulation tab, when its analysis is enabled, allows specification of the Tripping solution. Click [ ] to open the selection window for the required Tripping element data file (*.trp).
Specifications made at the GUI for the ac contingency solution are retained for future activities. If an activity that does not require a Tripping Element Data file is initiated, and Perform tripping simulation had been previously selected, an error message requesting the file will pop up. Deselect Perform tripping simulation to run the activity without specifying the file.
11-29
The Corrective Actions tab, when its analysis is enabled, allows specification of the desired Constraint options and Control options.
Figure 11-22. Multi-Level AC Contingency Solution Dialog, Corrective Actions Click [Solve] when all the desired functions have been enabled. A summary of the solution process is routed to the Report tab.
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
11-30
For each contingency, automatic contingency analysis imposes the contingency, implements generation re-dispatch if a generation dispatch mode is enabled, and solves AC power flow solution sequentially. The [Implement Generation Dispatch] dialog requires entering the filename of the study case. It permits the user to enable Dispatch mode for one of the following conditions: Subsystem machines (Reserve) Subsystem machines (PMAX) Subsystem machines (Inertia) Subsystem machines (Governor droop)
Click [ ] to open the selection window for the required Distribution factor data file (*.dfx). If desired, an optional Load throwover data file (*.thr) may also be specified. If a dispatch mode is enabled, a Unit Inertia and Governor Data file (*.inl) input file may be specified. The basis of the study must be specified as either the Working case or Impose contingency from the pull-down list of contingencies. Click [OK] to process the study. Solution output is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 11-7).
11-31
Section 6.9.4, About Generation Dispatch Section 6.10.7, Implementing Generation Dispatch Algorithm in Contingency Analysis
11-32
11.7 PV Analysis
Requirements / Prerequisites
Validly specified power flow case solved to an acceptable mismatch tolerance. Distribution Factor Data File (*.dfx) corresponding to the network condition.
The [PV Analysis] dialog (Figure 11-25) requires the specification of Solution options, a Solution Engine, VAR limit code application, Subsystem selection, and a number of filters that define analysis results. The following Transfer dispatch methods are available for both study and opposing systems:
DFAX generation DFAX load DFAX generation or load Subsystem load Subsystem machines (MW) Subsystem machines (MBASE) Subsystem machines (reserve) Subsystem machines (ECDI)
Click [ ] to open the selection window for the required Distribution Factor Data file (*.dfx). If desired, an optional Load Throwover Data file (*.thr) and Economic Dispatch file (*.ecd) may also be specified. Output results can be written to a PV Results file (*.pv), which can be a new file or a previouslybuilt file to be over-written. Click [Go] to perform the activity. A summary is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 11-26) and [PV Results] (Figure 11-27) is displayed.
11-33
11-34
11-35
Figure 11-27. PV Results Window Double-click in the graph area to open the [Graph Area Visual Parameters] dialog if you wish to change the colors and line style of the display.
11-36
Figure 11-28. Graph Area Visual Parameters Dialog To adjust parameters such as decimal places and axis labels, left-click the axis of interest. The scale values dialogs are displayed in Figure 11-29 and Figure 11-30 for both vertical and horizontal axes. Values: Specify a top value and bottom values of the axes. These values can be adjusted based in grid step size if Adjust for grid step is checked. Select the start point of the grid step. If undefined then grid step will start from bottom. Select grid step method either by step value or defined the number of values required on the axes. View (not real values): Select the graphs display options in this section. The changes will be reflected on the sample display on the left.
11-37
11-38
Figure 11-30. Horizontal Scale Adjustment Dialog Select the Type of results desired. Highlight at least one of the Contingencies and one of the Buses to view the graphic. To select individual items, left-click the item you want to select. Hold the [Ctrl] key down while clicking the left mouse button to select the additional items. To select continuous items, hold the [Shift] key down while clicking the left mouse button. Click [Printing options] (Figure 11-31) to select desired output options. Click [Graphics] to view only the graphics area (Figure 11-32). Click [Print] to route the graphic to a print queue.
11-39
11-40
Figure 11-33. Implement PV Transfer Dialog The implement PV transfer activity changes the generation or load, as appropriate, at those subsystem buses participating in the transfer. Details on the transfer may be examined using the Powerflow Cases tab of the File > Compare menu entry (see Figure 9-3).
11-41
PV Analysis
Click [Select] to open the directory of PV Results files. Open the desired file. The [PV Parameters] dialog displays the parameters specified for the creation of that file.
Figure 11-34. PV Parameters Dialog Click [Show results] to display [PV Results] (Figure 11-27).
11-42
11.8 QV Analysis
Requirements / Prerequisites
Validly specified power flow case solved to an acceptable mismatch tolerance. Distribution Factor Data File (*.dfx) corresponding to the network condition.
The [QV Analysis] dialog (Figure 11-35) requires the specification of a Bus subsystem Solution options, a Solution Engine, VAR limit code application, and a number of filters that define analysis results. Click [ ] to open the selection window for the required Distribution factor data file (*.dfx). If desired, an optional Load throwover data file (*.thr) may also be specified. Output results can be written to a QV Results file (*.qv), which can be a new file or a previously-built file to be over-written. Click [Go] to perform the activity. A summary is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 11-36) and [QV Results] (Figure 11-37) is displayed.
11-43
11-44
Figure 11-37. QV Results Window To change the graph area display, see Figures 11-28, 11-29, and 11-30. Highlight at least one of the Contingencies to view the graphic. To select individual items, left-click the item you want to select. Hold the [Ctrl] key down while clicking the left mouse button to select the additional items. To select continuous items, hold the [Shift] key down while clicking the left mouse button. Click [Printing options] (Figure 11-31) to select desired output options. Click [Graphics] to view only the graphics area (Figure 11-38). Click [Print] to route the graphic to a print queue.
11-45
11-46
QV Analysis
Click [Select] to open the directory of QV results files (*.qv). Open the desired file. The [QV Parameters] dialog displays the parameters specified for the creation of that file.
Figure 11-39. QV Parameters Dialog Click [Show results] to display [QV Results] (Figure 11-37).
11-47
The [Probabilistic Reliability Assessment] dialog (Figure 11-40) provides a variety of analysis options with report options available in the following formats:
with filters for Probability cutoff and Frequency cutoff for the following formats:
System problem probabilistic indices System load curtailment probabilistic indices Bus load curtailment probabilistic indices Branch flow overloading probabilistic indices Bus voltage violation probabilistic indices Contingency summary with outage statistics
Click [ ] to open the selection windows for the required Distribution Factor Data file (*.dfx) and Contingency Solution Output file (*.acc). If deterministic reliability indices are computed, a Reliability Outage Statistics file (*.prb) is not required. Click [Solve] to process the working case. Solution output is routed to the Report tab by default (Figure 11-41).
11-48
11-49
Figure 11-41. Probabilistic Reliability Assessment Output, System Problem Summary, Post Contingency
11-50
The [Substation Reliability Assessment] dialog (Figure 11-42) provides a variety of analysis options. Branch rating set and Flow rating percentage Include system tie lines to source/sink systems Frequency cutoff Peak load percentage Switching time Stuck breaker fault rate
Report format: allows user selection from among the following reports: Substation component report Contingency report Bus load curtailment report Substation load curtailment report
Subsystem selection: allows user specification of the extent of the analysis, to include: Substation system Source system Sink system
Click [ ] to open the selection windows for the required Distribution factor data file (*.dfx) and Reliability Outage Statistics file (*.prb) files. Click [Solve] to process the working case. Solution output is routed to the Report tab by default.
11-51
SUBSTATION
SOURCE
SINK
C:\LocalDocs\test_case\substation\sub1.dfx
11-52
11-53
11-54
Chapter 12
Power Flow Data Verification
PSSE provides a variety of means by which data can be validated in order to identify suspect parameters, conflicting voltage controls, unacceptable tap controls, and isolated buses or inadvertent islands. The data checking is accompanied by the generation of reports at the Report device for examination. Data checking does not validate the state of a power flow solution.
The branch parameter checking activity BRCH tabulates those branches where impedances or other characteristics are such that they may be detrimental to the rate of convergence of one or more of the power flow solution activities. In the [Check Branch Parameters] dialog (Figure 12-1), one or more data checks may be selected. Seven of the checks use limit or threshold values. The threshold values shown on the dialog may be used, or you may specify different values that might be more appropriate for the working case under examination. Threshold values are specified either by typing them directly in the data value fields or by using the up and down arrow buttons next to each input field. The check box for the final check, missing zero sequence impedance, is disabled if sequence data is not present in the working case. The [Check Branch Parameters] dialog enables the user to designate for processing either the entire working case or a specified bus subsystem (refer to Section 4.8, Subsystem Selection of the PSS E Program Operation Manual). A bus subsystem may be specified either via a [Bus Subsystem Selector] dialog by clicking [Select...], or by entering buses directly in the [Check Branch Parameters] dialog
12-1
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS PSSE Application Program Interface (API), Section 1.26, BRCH
12-2
The bus scheduled voltage checking activity CNTB tabulates the voltage setpoints and desired voltage bands of voltage controlling equipment in the working case, and, optionally, allows the user to specify new scheduled voltages. It also performs certain checks on voltage controlling buses that are not themselves voltage controlled buses. It may be instructed to process all such buses, or only those with suspect or conflicting voltage schedules or other errors. In the [Check / Change Controlled Bus Scheduled Voltages] dialog (Figure 12-2), three control options are specified: Process either all voltage controlled and controlling buses in the subsystem, or only those with apparent conflicting voltage objective data or other errors: Either operate in an interactive mode, in which new voltage schedules may be specified, or in a reporting mode: Either include or omit Type 4 controlled buses and out-of-service or disabled controlling equipment in its checking and reporting.
The [Check / Change Controlled Bus Scheduled Voltages] dialog enables the user to designate for processing either the entire working case or a specified bus subsystem (refer to Section 4.8, Subsystem Selection of the PSSE Program Operation Manual). A bus subsystem may be specified either via a [Bus Subsystem Selector] dialog by clicking [Select...], or by entering buses directly in the [Check / Change Controlled Bus Scheduled Voltages] dialog.
12-3
If the voltage schedule changing option was specified, as each voltage controlled bus is processed, the user has the option of entering a new scheduled voltage (Figure 12-3).
Figure 12-3. Change Voltage Setpoint Dialog Any voltage controlling transformers with load drop compensation that are controlling voltage at the controlled bus being processed are listed. A new voltage band may be specified for any or all of such transformers (Figure 12-4).
Section 5.28, Checking/Changing Controlled Bus Scheduled Voltage PSSE Application Program Interface (API), Section 1.36, CNTB
12-4
The controlling transformer parameter checking activity TPCH performs several checks on the adjustment data associated with voltage and flow controlling transformers. In the [Check / Change Transformer Adjustment Data] dialog (Figure 12-5), data checks are selected through check boxes. Those checks that use a threshold value have a value field next to the test description; you may override any default threshold by typing the desired value in its field. The [Check / Change Transformer Adjustment Data] dialog enables the user to designate for processing either the entire working case or a specified bus subsystem (refer to Section 4.8, Subsystem Selection of the PSSE Program Operation Manual). A bus subsystem may be specified either via a [Bus Subsystem Selector] dialog by clicking [Select...], or by entering buses directly in the [Check / Change Transformer Adjustment Data] dialog. If any transformers are listed as failing a check, the user has the option of modifying the data of all transformers tabulated (Figure 12-6).
12-5
12-6
Section 5.29, Checking/Changing Transformer Adjustment Data PSSE Application Program Interface (API), Section 1.245, TPCH
12-7
Power Flow Data Verification Check for Islands Without a Swing Bus
Power Flow > Check Data > Buses not in swing tree (TREE)
The network continuity checking activity TREE enables the user to identify buses not connected back to a Type 3 (swing) bus through the in-service ac network. It also tabulates in-service branches connected to Type 4 (disconnected) buses. Each swingless island may optionally be disconnected. For each swingless island is detected, a dialog is brought up which allows the user to select the next action of activity TREE: Click [Yes] to disconnect this island, and then check for another swingless island. Click [No] to leave this island unchanged and check for another swingless island. Click [Cancel] to leave this island unchanged and exit activity TREE.
12-8
Chapter 13
Linear Network Analysis
13.1 Building the Distribution Factor Data File
Activity DFAX
Requirements / Prerequisites Validly specified power flow case solved to an acceptable mismatch tolerance.
Subsystem Description File Monitored Element Description File Contingency Description FIle
Power Flow > Linear Network > Build distribution factor data file (DFAX)
This activity builds the ac contingency analysis distribution factor file. Click [ ] to open selection windows for each of the required files.
Figure 13-1. Build Distribution Factor Data File Dialog (EXAMPLE Input Files)
13-1
The data files available in the PSSE EXAMPLE directory can be selected to test the process. A filename for the Distribution Factor Data Output file (*.dfx) is required; it can be a new file or a previously-built file to be over-written. Line outage distribution factors are used by activity DFAX for building Distribution Factor Data Files for specific PSSE activities as follows: Prepare files for use with AC analysis only: activities ACCC, IMPC, and LLRF (Section 11.3 and Chapter 18) Prepare files for use with AC and/or DC analysis: AC analysis plus activities OTDF, DCCC, TLTG, SPIL, and POLY (Sections 13.2, 13.6, 13.8, 13.9, and 13.10)
Since the information stored in the Distribution Factor Data File is a function of data organization and network topology in the working case, it follows that it must be re-executed before running the desired activity. Calculation results are routed to the Progress tab.
Figure 13-2. Example of Output from Building the Distribution Factor Data File
13-2
This activity opens a selection screen listing available Distribution Factor Data files. Highlight the desired file and click [Open] to complete the process. By default, the report (example provided below) is directed to the Report tab.
13-3
13-4
Linear Network Analysis Estimating Severity Rankings for Single Line Outage Contingencies
Default solution and output control parameters may be changed using the [Single Contingency Ranking] dialog (Figure 13-5). Click [ ] to open selection windows for each of the required files. A filename for the Contingency Solution Output file (*.acc) is required. Click [OK] to perform the activity. A summary is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 13-6).
13-5
Linear Network Analysis Estimating Severity Rankings for Single Line Outage Contingencies
13-6
Linear Network Analysis Estimating Severity Rankings for Single Line Outage Contingencies
Section 7.3, Estimating Severity Rankings for Single Line Outage Contingencies
13-7
Power Flow > Linear Network > Create/modify SUB, MON and CON configuration files
The [Configuration File Builder] dialog provides a method to create or modify supporting Input files that build the Distribution Factor Data file (see Section 13.1) one at a time or in a group. While not every complex contingency can be created using [Configuration File Builder], most of the commonly used contingencies can be created with just a few clicks. If a text file editor has been specified (see Changing Program Preferences), additional contingencies can be added to the configuration files created by [Configuration File Builder] by clicking [Edit...].
13-8
13-9
Section 7.1.2, Subsystem Description Data File Contents Section 7.1.3, Monitored Element Data File Contents Section 7.1.4, Contingency Description Data File Contents
13-10
The dc power flow model is useful for rapid calculation of real power flow. The [DC Network Solution and Report] dialog requires the specification of status change for either a branch or a 3-winding transformer in the change case. It provides options to save one of the following voltage specifications: Original voltages Base case dc power flow voltage angle Change case dc power flow voltage angle
13-11
Click [Go] to perform the activity. The report is routed to the Report tab by default (Figure 13-9).
Additional Information
PSSE Program Operation Manual, Section 7.4, Applying the DC Linearized Network Solution
13-12
This activity estimates flows on a set of monitored elements for the base case and for a specified set of contingency cases, producing either an overload report or a loading table for each case. The [DC Contingency Checking] dialog (Figure 13.8) provides a variety of solution and output options. Click [ ] to open the selection window for the required Distribution factor data file (*.dfx). The Distribution Factor Data file must contain distribution factors to perform this activity. Rerun Building the Distribution Factor Data File with with the Calculate Distribution factors option selected if a warning is displayed.
Figure 13-10. DC Contingency Checking Dialog Click [Go] to perform the activity. The contingency event summary is routed to the Report tab by default (Figure 13-11).
13-13
Additional Information
PSSE Program Operation Manual, Section 7.5, Calculating Linearized Network Contingency
13-14
The [DC Corrective Actions] dialog (Figure 13.7) provides a variety of constraint and control options. Click [ ] to open the selection window for the required Distribution factor data file (*.dfx). The Distribution Factor Data file must contain distribution factors to perform this activity. Rerun Building the Distribution Factor Data File with the Prepare files for use with AC and/or DC analysis option selected if a warning is displayed.
Figure 13-12. DC Corrective Actions Dialog Click [Solve] to perform the activity. A summary is routed to the Progress tab.
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
13-15
The [Transmission Interchange Limits Calculation] dialog (Figure 13-13) provides a variety of solution and output options. Click [ ] to open the selection window for the required Distribution Factor Data file (*.dfx). The Distribution Factor Data file must contain distribution factors to perform this activity. Rerun Building the Distribution Factor Data File with the Calculate Distribution factors option selected if a warning is displayed. Click [OK] to perform the activity. A summary of the activity is routed to the Progress tab. The analysis is routed to the Report tab by default (Figure 13-14).
13-16
13-17
13-18
13-19
The [Sequential Participation Interchange Limit] dialog (Figure 13-18) requires specification of the subsystems to be tested and solution and output options. Click [ ] to open the selection windows for the required Distribution Factor Data file (*.dfx) and an appropriate Subsystem Participation Data file (*.prt) (see PSSE Program Operation Manual Section 7.8.1, Subsystem Participation Data File Contents). Click [OK] to perform the activity. An activity summary is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 13-19). The study is routed to the Report tab by default (Figures 13-20, 13-21, 13-22, and 13-23).
13-20
13-21
13-22
13-23
13-24
Linear Network Analysis Running Interchange Limit Analysis with Two Opposing Systems
The [Interchange Limits with Two Opposing Systems] dialog (Figure 13-24) requires specification of the subsystems to be tested and solution and output options. Click [ ] to open the selection window for the required Distribution factor data file (*.dfx). If the data is to be saved in a file, a filename for the POLY Results file (*.pol) is required; it can be a new file or a previously-built file to be overwritten. Click [Go] to perform the activity. An activity summary is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 13-25). The analysis is routed to the Report tab by default (Figures 13-26, 13-27, and 13-28). The [POLY plotting] dialog displays visual analysis and printing options (Figure 13-29). Highlight the desired analysis in the Plots column (base case, contingency, or all cases) to display the interchange limits. A description of the contingency is displayed as a label for the dialog. Highlight the desired analysis in the Printing column and click [Print] to print a hard copy.
13-25
Linear Network Analysis Running Interchange Limit Analysis with Two Opposing Systems
13-26
Linear Network Analysis Running Interchange Limit Analysis with Two Opposing Systems
Figure 13-25. Interchange Limits with Two Opposing Systems Activity Output
13-27
Linear Network Analysis Running Interchange Limit Analysis with Two Opposing Systems
13-28
Linear Network Analysis Running Interchange Limit Analysis with Two Opposing Systems
Section 7.9, Performing Interchange Limit Analysis with Two Opposing Systems
13-29
Linear Network Analysis Running Interchange Limit Analysis with Two Opposing Systems
Click [Select] to open the directory of POLY Results files. Open the desired file. The [POLY Parameters] dialog displays the parameters specified for the creation of that file.
13-30
This activity was incorporated into PSSE for the convenience of customers who use Midwest ISO (http://www.midwestiso.org/home) planning algorithms. Please contact MISO for current updates, as Siemens PTI does not provide warranty or support for Midwest Independent Transmission System Operator solutions.
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
13-31
13-32
Chapter 14
Network Reduction
14.1 Building a Network Equivalent
Power Flow > Equivalence Networks
The [Equivalence Networks] dialog prepares five different modeling options, enabled from separate tabs.
The Build electrical equivalent (EEQV) tab on [Equivalence Networks] (Figure 14-1) provides an option to equivalence inside or outside a selected subsystem. Checkboxes are provided to enable or disable various options, and filters are supplied for Minimum generation and Branch threshold tolerance that may also be applied to the selection of All buses. Click [Go] to perform the activity. A summary is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 14-1).
14-1
14-2
The Net generation with load (NETG/GNET) tab on [Equivalence Networks] (Figure 14-3) provides an option to equivalence inside or outside a selected subsystem. Click [Go] to perform the activity. The Progress tab displays the message GENERATION AT <quantity> BUSES NETTED WITH THEIR LOAD.
Section 8.4, Applying Net Generation with Load at All Non-Boundary Buses Section 8.5, Applying Net Generation with Load at All Buses Except Boundary Buses
14-3
The Equivalence radial / 2-point buses (EQRD/RDEQ) tab on the [Equivalence Networks] dialog (Figure 14-4) provides an option to equivalence inside or outside a selected subsystem. Checkboxes are provided to enable or disable various options that may also be applied to the selection of All buses. Click [Go] to perform the activity. The Progress tab displays the message <quantity> BUSES EQUIVALENCED.
Section 8.6, Equivalencing Radial Buses Section 8.7, Equivalencing Radial Buses, with Exception
14-4
The Net boundary bus mismatches (BGEN) tab on [Equivalence Networks] (Figure 14-5) requires the user to select a Boundary bus modification from among the following options: Generator for inflow, load for outflow All equivalent generators All equivalent loads
Click [Go] to perform the activity. The Report tab displays the message NO MISMATCHES ABOVE <quantity> FOUND.
14-5
Reading Sequence Data for Fault Analysis Converting Loads and Generators Using Classical Fault Analysis Option The Build three sequence equivalent (SCEQ) tab on [Equivalence Networks] (Figure 14-6) provides a checkbox to enable Apply impedance correction to zero sequence and a filter for Branch threshold tolerance. Click [ ] to open selection windows to save data of the external system to be equivalenced in a Power Flow Raw Data file (*.raw) or a Sequence Data file (*.seq), either of which can be a new file or a previously-built file to be over-written. Click [Go] to perform the activity. A summary is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 14-7).
14-6
14-7
14-8
Chapter 15
Unbalanced Fault Analysis
15.1 Preparing Sequence Networks for Unbalanced Network Solution
Activity SEQD
Requirements / Prerequisites Validly specified power flow case, with sequence data appended, solved to an acceptable mismatch level with bus voltages corresponding to prefault network condition.
The sequence network set up activity is a prerequisite for running an unbalanced network solution (activity SCMU) or the separate pole circuit breaker duty (activity SPCB). If dc lines or FACTS devices are present in the working case, the [Setup Network for Unbalanced Solution] dialog (Figure 15-1) requires specification of an option to block or convert their data.
Figure 15-1. Setup Network for Unbalanced Solution Dialog Click [OK] to perform the activity. Results of the preparation for use in SCMU or SPCB are routed to the Progress tab (Figure 15-2). However, this activity does not modify the contents of the working case.
15-1
Unbalanced Fault Analysis Preparing Sequence Networks for Unbalanced Network Solution
15-2
Reading Sequence Data for Fault Analysis Preparing Sequence Networks for Unbalanced Network Solution
The [Multiple Simultaneous Unbalances] dialog (Figure 15-3) prepares up to nine different modeling options, enabled from separate tabs as follows: [Select] opens [Bus Selection] options
3 phase fault first line-to-ground fault second line-to-ground fault first line-line-to-ground fault second line-line-to-ground fault 1 phase closed 2 phases closed
The All unbalances status column color-codes available unbalances for reference. The Solution Output tab requires Branch quantity desired to be expressed as one of the following: Currents Apparent impedances Apparent admittances
Click [Go] to perform the activity. A summary is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 15-4), and the report is routed to the Report tab by default (Figure 15-5).
15-3
Figure 15-4. Example of Multiple Simultaneous Unbalances Activity Output with Network Setup Option Selected
15-4
15-5
Unbalanced Fault Analysis Running Detailed Fault Analysis under Unbalance Condition
Reading Sequence Data for Fault Analysis Running Fault Analysis under Unbalance Condition
The [Multiple Unbalanced Solution Output] dialog (Figure 15-6) requires Branch quantity desired to be expressed as one of the following: Currents Apparent impedances Apparent admittances
Click [Go] to perform the activity. The report is displayed in the Report tab by default (Figure 15-6).
15-6
Unbalanced Fault Analysis Running Detailed Fault Analysis under Unbalance Condition
15-7
If sequence data is not present in the working case, only three phase faults will be calculated. The [Automatic Sequence Fault Calculation] dialog (Figure 15-8) provides checkboxes to enable six types of fault application and other model conditions. The user must specify one of the following output options: Total fault currents I"k contributions to N levels away Total fault currents and I"k contributions to N levels away
Click [ ] to open the selection window for a Fault Control Data file (*.fcd). A Relay Output Data file (*.rel) and a Short Circuit Output file (*.sc) may be specified to save the model data. Click [Go] to perform the activity. A summary is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 15-8), and the report is routed to the Report tab by default (Figure 15-8). You will need to click [Close] to end this activity.
15-8
15-9
The [ANSI Fault Current Calculation] dialog (Figure 15-9) provides Fault Specifications to be input from an ANSI Fault Specification Data file (*.ans) or interactively. Select the Interactive fault specification option and click [Select] to choose buses from the [Bus Selection] dialog. Click [Add to list] to display the [Add Bus] dialog (Figure 15-10), where the default Maximum operating voltage and Contact parting time may be changed. Click [Save] to add the bus to the list. Specifications may be made for branch and machine Divisors. The user must select a Fault multiplying factor. The calculation is output using one of the following formats: Summary output using ANSI X only (blank delimited fields) Summary output using ANSI X only (comma delimited fields) Detailed output using ANSI X only Detailed output using ANSI R and X Summary output using ANSI R and X (blank delimited fields) Summary output using ANSI R and X (comma delimited fields)
Click [Go] to perform the activity. A summary is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 15-11), and the report is routed to the Report tab by default (Figure 15-12).
15-10
15-11
15-12
The [Setup for Special Fault Calculations] dialog (Figure 15-13) prepares three different modeling options. Select Set classical short circuit assumptions for this activity. Checkboxes are then available to enable Set tap ratios to unity and Set charging to zero. The user must specify shunt configuration from the following options: Leave shunts unchanged Set shunts to zero in positive sequence Set shunts to zero in all sequences
Click [OK] to perform the activity. The message SELECTED FLAT CHANGES IMPOSED is displayed in the Progress tab.
Figure 15-13. Setup for Special Fault Calculations Dialog, Classical Fault Analysis
Additional Information
PSSE Program Operation Manual, Section 9.11, Using Classical Fault Analysis Assumptions
15-13
Unbalanced Fault Analysis Calculating Short Circuit Currents According to IEC 60909 Standard
The [IEC 60909 Fault Calculation] dialog (Figure 15-14) provides checkboxes to enable fault application. The user must also specify an option from each of the following: Output option: Total fault currents I"k contributions to N levels away Total fault currents and I"k contributions to N levels away
Fault location: Network bus LV bus of Power Station Unit (PSU) Auxiliary transformer (connected to PSU) LV bus
Shunt option: Set shunts to zero in positive sequence Set shunts to zero in all sequences Leave shunts unchanged
Line charging: Set line charging to zero in positive sequence Set line charging to zero in all sequences Leave line charging unchanged
Click [ ] to open selection windows for an IEC Fault Calculation Data file (*.iec) and a Fault Control Data file (*.fcd). A Short Circuit Output file (*.sc) may be specified to save the model data. Click [Go] to perform the activity. A summary is output to the Progress tab and the report is displayed in the Report tab by default.
15-14
Unbalanced Fault Analysis Calculating Short Circuit Currents According to IEC 60909 Standard
Section 9.12, Calculating Short Circuit Currents According to IEC 60909 Standard
15-15
The [Circuit Breaker Interrupting Duty] dialog (Figure 15-15) provides a checkbox to enable fault specifications from a previously saved file. Click [ ] to open selection windows for the required
Breaker Duty Data file (*.bkd) and the desired Fault Specification Data file (*.bkf).
Click [Go] to perform the activity. A summary is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 15-16), and the report is routed to the Report tab by default (Figure 15-17).
15-16
15-17
The [Separate Pole Circuit Breaker] dialog (Figure 15-18) requires specification of the Out-ofservice branch for unbalance. Click [Select] to display the [Branch Selection] dialog, from which the out-of-service branch must be selected. The Unbalance type must be specified as one of the following options: No unbalance reporting One phase open (checkbox for Include a path to ground and impedance filter option) Two phases open In-line fault One breaker (checkbox for Include a path to ground and impedance filter option) No unbalance
The in-line fault option may be further specified as: Line-to-ground (with impedance filter) Line-line-to-ground (with impedance filters) Three phase
Click [Go] to perform the activity. A summary is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 15-18), and the report is routed to the Report tab by default (Figure 15-18).
15-18
15-19
15-20
15-21
15-22
Chapter 16
Power Flow Reports
16.1 Area/Zone-Based Reports
16.1.1 Area-to-Area Interchange
Activity INTA
Requirements / Prerequisites Validly specified power flow case solved to an acceptable mismatch tolerance.
The [Area/Zone Based Reports] dialog (Figure 16-1) provides options for interchange reports and tie line loading reports, of all subsystems or selected subsystems, by area or zone.
16-1
Figure 16-1. Area/Zone Based Reports Dialog, Area Click [Go] to produce the report (Figure 16-2), which is displayed in the Report tab by default.
16-2
The [Area/Zone Based Reports] dialog (Figure 16-3) provides options for interchange reports and tie line loading reports, of all subsystems or selected subsystems, by area or zone.
Figure 16-3. Area/Zone Based Reports Dialog, Zone Click [Go] to produce the report (Figure 16-4), which is displayed in the Report tab by default.
16-3
16-4
The [Area/Zone Based Reports] dialog (Figure 16-5) provides options for interchange reports and tie line loading reports, of all subsystems or selected subsystems, by area or zone.
Figure 16-5. Area/Zone Based Reports Dialog, Area Tie Line Loadings Click [Go] to produce the report (Figure 16-9), which is displayed in the Report tab by default.
16-5
16-6
The [Area/Zone Based Reports] dialog (Figure 16-5) provides options for interchange reports and tie line loading reports, of all subsystems or selected subsystems, by area or zone.
Figure 16-7. Area/Zone Based Reports Dialog, Zone Tie Line Loadings Click [Go] to produce the report (Figure 16-9), which is displayed in the Report tab by default.
16-7
16-8
The [Area/Owner/Zone Totals] dialog (Figure 16-9) provides options for subsystem totals, of all subsystems or selected subsystems, by area, owner, or zone. The area report may also include zone subtotals.
Figure 16-9. Area/Owner/Zone Totals Dialog, Area Click [Go] to produce the report (Figure 16-10), which is displayed in the Report tab by default.
16-9
16-10
The [Area/Owner/Zone Totals] dialog (Figure 16-11) provides options for subsystem totals, of all subsystems or selected subsystems, by area, owner, or zone:
Figure 16-11. Area/Owner/Zone Totals Dialog, Owner Click [Go] to produce the report (Figure 16-12), which is displayed in the Report tab by default.
16-11
16-12
The [Area/Owner/Zone Totals] dialog (Figure 16-11) provides options for subsystem totals, of all subsystems or selected subsystems, by area, owner, or zone. The zone report may also include area subtotals.
Figure 16-13. Area/Owner/Zone Totals Dialog, Zone Click [Go] to produce the report (Figure 16-12), which is displayed in the Report tab by default.
16-13
16-14
16-15
In the [Bus Based Reports] dialog (Figure 16-15), select Powerflow output with the Wide format output check box unchecked. Click [Go] to produce the report (Figure 16-16).
16-16
16-17
In the [Bus Based Reports] dialog (Figure 16-17), select Powerflow output with the Wide format output check box checked and the Output with amps check box unchecked. Click [Go] to produce the report (Figure 16-18).
16-18
16-19
16.3.3 Wide-Format Power Flow Solution Report with Branch Current Loadings
Activity LAMP
Requirements / Prerequisites Validly specified power flow case solved to an acceptable mismatch tolerance.
In the [Bus Based Reports] dialog (Figure 16-19), select Powerflow output with the Wide format output and Output with amps check boxes both checked. Click [Go] to produce the report (Figure 16-20).
Figure 16-19. Bus Based Reports Dialog, Wide Format, with Branch Current Loadings
16-20
Figure 16-20. Example of Wide Format Power Flow Solution Report with Branch Current Loadings
16-21
In the [Bus Based Reports] dialog (Figure 16-21), select Subsystem summary / totals. Click [Go] to produce the report (Figure 16-22).
16-22
16-23
The load reduction reporting activity LODR summarizes the reduction in: Nominal constant MVA load caused when voltage at a load bus falls below PQBRAK. Nominal constant current load caused when voltage at a load bus falls below 0.5 pu.
In the [Bus Based Reports] dialog (Figure 16-23), select Load reduction output. If subsystem selection by area, owner and/or zone had been specified, select the desired option for defining subsystem loads. Click [Go] to produce the report.
16-24
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, Section 10.6, Summarizing Load Reduction PSS
16-25
The [Limit Checking Reports] dialog provides tabs to produce all PSSE limit checking reports: Machine Reactive Capability Generator Bus Limits Machine Terminal Limits Transmission Line Overloads Transformer Overloads Branch Overloads Transmission Line Overloads Transformer Overloads Branch Current Ratings Voltage Controlled Buses Controlling Transformers Out-of-limit Bus Voltage
Note that each report can be restricted by Area, Owner, Zone, Base kV and Bus, using the Select option of the dialog.
16-26
Clicking the Reactive capability tab in [Limit Checking Reports] will generate a report that tabulates machine loading and limit data. There is a checkbox option to update the machine reactive power limits in the power flow case. The PSSE Program Operation Manual (Section 10.21.1) provides details of the data records for the required Machine Capability Data file (*.gcp).
Section 10.21, Producing a Machine Reactive Capability Report Section 10.21.1, Machine Capability Curve Data File Contents
16-27
Clicking the Generator bus tab in [Limit Checking Reports] will generate a report that tabulates the loading and voltage conditions at generator buses. The following reports can be selected: Var limited plants with unequal var limits All var limited plants On-line plants All plants
16-28
Clicking the Machine terminal tab in [Limit Checking Reports] will generate a report that tabulates machine loading and voltage conditions at the generator terminals of on-line machines at type two and three buses in the working case. The report may include all on-line machines or only those that are overloaded.
Figure 16-27. Example of Machine Terminal Limits Report, Overloaded Machines Only
16-29
Clicking the Branches tab in [Limit Checking Reports] and then selecting the both transformer and non-transformer branches option from the pull-down list will generate a report that tabulates branch
overloads. Options are available to specify the Rating Set and Percent Loading limit.
16-30
Clicking the Branches tab in [Limit Checking Reports] and then selecting the only non-transformer branches option from the pull-down list will generate a report that tabulates transmission line overloads. Options are available to specify the Rating Set and Percent Loading limit.
16-31
Clicking the Branches tab in [Limit Checking Reports] and then selecting the only transformers option from the pull-down list will generate a report that tabulates transformer overloads. Options are
available to specify the Rating Set and Percent Loading limit.
16-32
Clicking the Branches tab in [Limit Checking Reports] provides options to include any of the following network components in the output: Include non-transformer branches that are not breakers or switches Include transformer branches Include branches that are breakers or switches.
Options are available to specify the Rating Set and Percent Loading limit.
Selecting all three network component options with the all ratings option will generate a report that tabulates branch current ratings.
Additional Information
PSSE Program Operation Manual, Section 10.19, Producing a Branch Current Ratings Report
16-33
Clicking the Regulated buses tab in [Limit Checking Reports] will generate a report that tabulates those buses where voltages are controlled by generation, switched shunts, voltage controlling transformers, FACTS devices, and/or VSC dc line converters.
16-34
Clicking the Controlling transformer tab in [Limit Checking Reports] will generate a report that tabulates those transformers in the power flow case where off-nominal turns ratio or phase-shift angle may be adjusted by power flow solution activities. The user has the option of listing All controlling transformers or of restricting the report to Controlling transformer violations, those transformers where the controlled quantity is outside of its specified band. The Output with voltage reversed option produces a report reversing the voltage option specified (pu or kV) in the Program Settings Dialog.
16-35
Clicking the Out-of-limit bus voltage tab in [Limit Checking Reports] will generate a report that tabulates those buses where voltage magnitude is outside the specified range. The example (Figure 16-34) is based on the default limits, which can be changed by the user in .01 pu increments.
16-36
The [AC Contingency Reports] dialog (Figure 16-35) allows the user to configure a variety of reports from the results of an ac contingency analysis. These formats include: Spreadsheet overload report Spreadsheet loading table Available capacity table Non-spreadsheet overload report Non-spreadsheet loading table Non-converged network Non-spreadsheet corrective actions
Checkboxes are available to enable/disable a variety of options, and filters may be set for a range of violations and tolerances. Details on the significance of the input parameters are discussed in the PSSE Program Operation Manual, Section 6.10.9. Click [ ] to open a selection window for the required Contingency solution output file (*.acc). Click [Go] to produce the report, which is displayed in the Report tab by default (Figure 16-36).
16-37
16-38
Refer to Refer to Additional Resources for PSSE, AcccBrwsGrid, for a description of ACCC postprocessor data format.
16-39
This activity preserves the output system conditions of a contingency case solution when a contingency case exceeds the capability of the ac contingency solution. The [Append to AC Contingency Solution Output File] dialog is used to specify: Contingency label: contingency identifier (12 characters) Contingency case title: up to sixteen lines of text describing the contingency Contingency file creation: the option to append to an existing Contingency solution output file (*.acc) or to create a new one the names of four files: Distribution Factor Data file (*.dfx) that specifies the network elements to be monitored Base case input file: Saved Case file (*.sav) containing the pre-contingency power flow case Contingency case input file: Saved Case file (*.sav) containing the contingency case solution to be appended Contingency solution output file (*.acc) into which the results of the specified contingency case are to be placed
Click [Go] to append the data; a summary is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 16-36).
16-40
16-41
The [Multiple AC Contingency Run Report] dialog (Figure 16-38) allows the user to configure a variety of reports from the results of multiple ac contingency analyses. These formats include: Monitored Elements Summary Missing Monitored Elements Missing Monitored Voltage Buses Missing Contingencies Non-converged Contingencies Base Case Loading Violations Contingency Case All Loading Violations Contingency Case Worst Case Loading Violations Base Case Voltage Violations Contingency Case All Voltage Violations Contingency Case Worst Case Voltage Violations
Checkboxes are available to enable/disable a variety of options, and filters may be set for a range of violations and tolerances. Details on the significance of the input parameters are discussed in the PSSE Program Operation Manual, Section 6.10.11. Click [ ] to open a selection window for the required Contingency Solution Output file (*.acc). As many as nine Contingency Solution Output files may be specified. Click [Go] to produce the report, which is displayed in the Report tab by default.
16-42
16-43
The multi-terminal dc line power flow output activity MTDC prints power flow solution results at all dc buses of all unblocked multi-terminal dc lines in the working case. Activity MTDC displays a popup message No unblocked multi-terminal dc lines in this case and terminates if these network conditions are not found. Click [OK] to remove the message. There are no user-defined options. The report is displayed in the Report tab by default (Figure 1639).
16-44
16-45
The [Area Subsystem Selector] dialog is similar to the area tab in the [Bus Subsystem Selector] (see Figure 2-9). The buttons respond the same way, but the Memorize and Recall options are not available. This dialog is used to limit report output and does not affect the [Spreadsheet] display.
16-46
16.8.2 By Owner
Subsystem > Owner
The [Owner Subsystem Selector] dialog is similar to the owner tab in the [Bus Subsystem Selector] (see Figure 2-9). The buttons respond the same way, but the Memorize and Recall options are not available. This dialog is used to limit report output and does not affect the [Spreadsheet] display.
16-47
16.8.3 By Zone
Subsystem > Zone
The [Zone Subsystem Selector] dialog is similar to the zone tab in the [Bus Subsystem Selector] (see Figure 2-9). The buttons respond the same way, but the Memorize and Recall options are not available. This dialog is used to limit report output and does not affect the [Spreadsheet] display.
16-48
Power Flow > Reports > Export ACCC, PV/QV results to Excel
OR
Start > Programs > PSSE > Export results to Excel
The [Export PSSE Data/Result to Excel] dialog (Figure 16-44) requires specification of the Contingency for export: ACCC Analysis Results PV Solution Results QV Solution Results
If ACCC Analysis Results is selected, additional options are available. Click [Options] to open [Specify psseexcel.accc Options] (Figure 16-43). The Solution Type (Contingency, Corrective Action, or Tripping), Rating, and filters for Bus and System Mismatch may be specified.
Figure 16-43. Specify psseexcel.accc Options Dialog Click [OK] to return to [Export PSSE Data/Result to Excel]. Click [ ] to open selection windows for the file to be exported and the Excel output file, which can be a new file with the default name of the *.acc file, a designated filename, or a previously-built file to be over-written. Checkboxes are provided to select the desired Quantities to Export and contingencies. Click [Export] to complete the action. The Excel Workbook will open in a new window.
16-49
16-50
Chapter 17
Balanced Switching
17.1 Converting Loads and Generators
Power Flow > Convert Loads and Generators
This task opens the [Convert / Reconstruct Loads and Generators] dialog where reallocations of constant MVA loads can be specified.
Figure 17-1. Convert / Reconstruct Loads and Generators Dialog Siemens Energy, Inc., Power Technologies International 17-1
17.1.1 Generators
Activity CONG
Requirements / Prerequisites Validly specified power flow case solved to an acceptable mismatch level. Machine impedance data must be correctly specified for all online machines. Power Flow > Convert Loads and Generators
Click the Convert Generators checkbox in [Convert / Reconstruct Loads and Generators] and select the desired machine impedance (ZSORCE for dynamic simulations or ZPOS for short circuit calculations) to convert generators for subsequent PSSE activities. Generators must be represented as current sources for the following activities:
Fault Analysis / Switching Analysis
Factorizing the Network AdmitRunning State-Space Reading Dynamics Model Data tance Matrix Simulation Solving the Converted Case Calculating Circuit Breaker Interrupting Duty Simulation Variables Subsystem Simulation Data Running Exciter Simulation Running Extended Term Dynamic Simulation
Restoring Dynamics Working Memory from a Binary SnapRunning Governor Response shot File Created in PSSE-26 Simulation Test or Earlier Modifying Dynamics Model Pointer Tables Creating a Dynamics Model Raw Data File
Displaying Model Data Displaying Model Storage
Locations
The notice GENERATOR CONVERSION COMPLETED is printed in the Progress tab and [Convert / Reconstruct Loads and Generators] displays Generators are converted when the conversion process is complete. You will need to click [Close] to end this activity.
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
17-2
Click the Convert/Reconstruct Loads checkbox in [Convert / Reconstruct Loads and Generators] and select the Convert constant MVA loads option to convert loads for subsequent PSSE activities. Options are available to change the default active and reactive power quantities. Loads to be converted can be selected by the Area, Zone or Owner number to which the loads are assigned (NOT to the bus assignment to which the loads are connected). When selected by kV, all loads connected to buses with the selected voltage(s) will be converted in the selected Areas, Zones and/or Owners. For most types of analyses, loads are converted for the following activities: Factorizing the Network Admittance Matrix Solving the Converted Case Calculating Circuit Breaker Interrupting Duty
The notice <quantity> LOADS CONVERTED DURING THIS STEP and <quantity> OF <quantity> LOADS CONVERTED is printed in the Progress tab when the conversion process is complete. The dialog closes automatically after load conversion.
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
17-3
Click the Convert/Reconstruct Loads checkbox in [Convert / Reconstruct Loads and Generators] and select one of the following options from the Operation pull-down list. Reconstruct loads using present voltage Reconstruct loads using unity voltage
The notice <quantity > LOADS CONVERTED DURING THIS STEP and <quantity > OF <quantity > LOADS CONVERTED is printed in the Progress tab when the reconstruction process is complete.
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
17-4
The network ordering process requires branch selection from the [Order Network] dialog (Figure 17-2) with the following options: Ignore out of service branches: recognize the status of network branches and ignore out-of-service branches in determining the bus ordering Assume all branches are in-service: ignore the service status of all branches and assume all branches connected to Type 1, 2, or 3 buses are in-service
Figure 17-2. Order Network Dialog The notice DIAGONALS = <quantity> OFF-DIAGONALS = <quantity> MAX SIZE = <quantity> is printed in the Progress tab when the network ordering process is complete.
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
17-5
The notice <quantity> DIAGONAL AND <quantity> OFF-DIAGONAL ELEMENTS is printed in the Progress tab when the factorization process is complete.
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
17-6
The user specifies the desired portion of the admittance matrix from the following options: All buses: the entire admittance matrix. Selected bus subsystem: admittance matrix rows corresponding to buses in the current bus subsystem, either as defined, or as redefined using [Select]. The following buses: only those buses specified.
Unless All buses is selected, the Include off-diagonal terms corresponding to ties in the specified subsystem check box is enabled. Select this option to display all non-zero off-diagonal terms in the rows being processed. If this check box option is not selected, only off-diagonal terms corresponding to other rows being processed are displayed. Direct the matrix to either a named file or to the Report tab using the Destination and data type options. When this matrix is generated by PSSE, buses connected together by zero impedance are combined together in the matrix. Therefore, the matrix may not have separate rows and columns for each bus. Instead one bus ID will represent the combined buses.
17-7
Converting Loads and Generators Load Characteristics Ordering Network Buses for Matrix Manipulation Factorizing the Network Admittance Matrix
The switching studies solution requires a starting point option from the [Solution for Switching Studies] dialog (Figure 17-5) with the following options: Flat start: all bus voltages are reset to unity magnitude at zero phase angle Use voltage vector as start point: existing voltage vector in the working case is used as the initial voltage estimate
17-8
17-9
17-10
Chapter 18
Transmission Pricing and Open Access
18.1 Open Access and Pricing Data
Trans Access > Data
The [Transaction Data] dialog (Figure 18-1) provides a form where Transactions are input. Click [Add] when the attribute data for a transaction has been completed. Then highlight the transaction and input Participating Buses data. Click [Add] in the buses dialog to complete the transaction data. Both attribute and bus data can be modified. Transaction data is not saved with the power flow case, but it can be saved/retrieved from external *.mwm files.
Input transaction attributes and then Add With the transaction highlighted in left window, add bus data
18-1
Transmission Pricing and Open Access Calculating Transaction Event Impact on Monitored Elements
The [Impact on Monitored Elements] dialog (Figure 18-2) calculates and reports the incremental MW flow impact on a set of monitored elements due to a single transaction event. Click [ ] to open the selection window for the required Distribution factor data file (*.dfx). If desired, an optional ATC Updates file (*.dat) may also be specified. Click [Go] to perform the activity.
18-2
The [Line Loading Relief by Transaction Adjustment] dialog (Figure 18-3) requires setting the desired Distribution factor tolerance. Then click [ ] to open the selection window for the required Distribution Factor Data file (*.dfx). Select a line loading relief function from among the following options: Curtail DF Report Restore
Highlight the desired monitored element and the desired priority. A priority may be modified with an adjustment method from among the following options: FILO (first in - last out) DF-Order (decreasing order of distribution factor magnitude) DF-Pro Rata (distribution factor pro rata) DF-Sched-Pro Rata (pro rata base on the product of distribution factor with transaction schedule
Click [OK] to produce the report (Figure 18-4), which is displayed in the Report tab by default.
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
18-3
18-4
Reading Transactions Raw Data Building the Distribution Factor Data File This activity performs various analyses related to identifying the MW-mile impact of transaction events on transmission facility owners.
The [Megawatt Shift Factors] dialog (Figure 18-5) requires a Shift factor selection, MW-mile or MW-ohm, to report the impact of a particular transaction event. Click [OK] to perform the analysis. The report is routed to the Report tab by default.
18-5
18-6
18-7
18-8
Chapter 19
Optimal Power Flow
19.1 Reading Optimal Power Flow Data
Activity ROPF
Requirements / Prerequisites Validly specified power flow case. Optimal Power Flow Data File (*.rop)
The file selection window in the [Open] dialog lists only those files available when the Files of type: field has been scrolled to the desired file type. For this activity, scroll to Optimal Power Flow Data file (*.rop). Highlight the desired file and click [Open]. The OPF data is read into the working case.
Additional Information
PSSE Program Operation Manual, Section 13.8.2, Optimal Power Flow Raw Data File
19-1
If optimal power flow data is not present in the working case, then the option to initialize OPF data is provided. Click [Yes] on the dialog (Figure 19-1) to configure [OPF Spreadsheet] and [OPF Tree] with the appropriate data categories to enter or modify constraint and control data.
Figure 19-1. OPF Initialization Pop-up Dialog If data is changed through the subsequent reading of an Optimal Power Flow Data file (*.rop), a summary of changes is routed to the Progress tab (see Figure 19-2).
Figure 19-2. Example of Bus Attribute Data Changed by OPF Data File The following sections describe the OPF attribute spreadsheets available after either data initialization or the reading of OPF data from a file. [OPF Spreadsheet] records display default data values until modified. Numeric data cells of the subsystem attribute spreadsheets support use of the summation ( + ) and multiplication ( ) operators. These operators may be used to automatically adjust numerical data by either a constant or a scale factor. The operators must be specified directly in front of the number. The following examples illustrate different uses of these operators:
19-2
If a floating point field contains the value 100, then the corresponding data item for each element in the specified subsystem will be set to 100.0. If a floating point field contains the value +100, then 100.0 is added to the present value of each data item within the specified subsystem. If a floating point field contains the value +-100, then 100 is subtracted from the present value of each data item within the specified subsystem. If a floating point field contains the value *1.1, then the presents values of each data item within the specified subsystem will be multiplied by 1.1.
It is not possible to add new records through an attribute spreadsheet, nor is it possible to introduce new buses through any of the OPF data input functions. Use [Network Spreadsheet] or [Diagram] to add a new bus and then, if desired, return to [OPF Spreadsheet] to modify the automatically created record. If a bus is removed from the power flow network, the corresponding [OPF Spreadsheet] record will also be removed.
Figure 19-3. Example of Bus Voltage Spreadsheet The Bus Number and Bus Name cells uniquely identify the record and cannot be edited. Values for Normal or Emergency Voltage Limits may be entered directly into the spreadsheet cells. An Adjust Limits cell provides a menu from which one of three options may be selected:
No Change Fix preserves the normal maximum and minimum voltage limits as indicated by the values in the Normal Voltage Limits Maximum and Minimum cells updates the Normal Voltage Limits Maximum and Minimum cells to reflect the present voltage magnitude of the bus
19-3
For example, if the Normal Voltage Limits Maximum and Minimum cells contain values of 1.05 and 0.95 respectively, and the present voltage magnitude of the bus is 0.92, then the Fix option will automatically update the values in both the Normal Voltage Limits Maximum and Minimum cells to reflect a value of 0.92.
Open
updates the Normal Voltage Limits Maximum or Minimum cell to reflect the present voltage magnitude of the bus, if the present voltage magnitude of the bus falls outside of the voltage range defined by the specified maximum or minimum voltage limits. For example, if the Normal Voltage Limits Minimum cell contains a value of 0.95 and the present voltage magnitude of the bus is 0.92, then when Open selected, the value in the Normal Voltage Limits Minimum cell will automatically be updated to reflect the value of 0.92. A similar action will result if the current voltage magnitude exceeds the maximum limit.
The Limit Type cell provides a menu from which one of the following options may be selected: Reporting Hard limit Soft-linear limit Soft-quadratic limit
A Soft Limit Penalty cell becomes active and the default value may be modified if either the Softlinear or Soft-quadratic limit type is selected in the Limit Type cell. Otherwise, this cell is locked.
Figure 19-4. Bus Voltage Subsystem Spreadsheet The Bus Voltage Subsystem spreadsheet is particularly helpful when establishing the same voltage attributes for all buses within a particular subsystem. Define the subsystem (see Section 2.3.2, Creating a Bus Subsystem). The values entered into the record are subsequently applied to all buses within the specified subsystem. Cells left blank, or set to No change, indicate that no changes are to be made to the present working case values. Values for Normal or Emergency Voltage Limits may be entered directly into the spreadsheet cells. The Normal and Emergency Voltage Limit cells support use of the summation ( + ) and multiplication ( ) operator functions. These operators may be used to automatically adjust the maximum and/or minimum voltage magnitudes at all buses within the specified subsystem by either a constant or a scale factor. Adjust Limits provides the options menu described for the Bus Voltage Attribute Spreadsheet. Limit Type cell also provides the options menu described for the Bus Voltage Attribute Spreadsheet, with the addition of a No change option to retain the current settings. A change to the Soft Limit Penalty
19-4
can be applied only if either the Soft-linear or Soft-quadratic limit type is selected in the Limit Type cell.
Figure 19-5. Example of Adjustable Bus Shunt Spreadsheet By default, all Adjustable Bus Shunt records within the working case are displayed. A limited set may be displayed by specifying a subsystem (see Section 2.3.2, Creating a Bus Subsystem). If no Adjustable Bus Shunt records exist in the working case, the Adjustable Bus Shunt spreadsheet will display a blank record. To add a new Adjustable Bus Shunt record, enter a valid bus number in the Bus Number cell of the row containing the and enter a bus shunt identifier in the Id cell. Unique shunt identifiers must be used if more than one Adjustable Bus Shunt record is to exist for the same bus number. Optionally, the Bus Number and bus shunt Id may correspond to a fixed shunt record in the power flow network. If so, then the corresponding fixed shunt data record may be updated with new BShunt (Mvar) data after an OPF solution. After the bus number and shunt identifier are entered, click on another row to retrieve the Bus Name; all other cells are populated with default data values. If another row is clicked before a new Id value is entered, the Id cell will be set to 1 and locked. Delete the record and re-enter it to reset the Id. New values for the Initial Susceptance, Maximum Susceptance, Minimum Susceptance or Cost Scale values may be entered directly in the cells provided. If desired, uncheck the In Service toggle switch to set the Adjustable Bus Shunt record to out-ofservice.
19-5
The Adjustable Bus Shunt Subsystem spreadsheet is particularly helpful in modifying and/or introducing a large number of adjustable bus shunts that all have the same values. It can also be used to delete a group of adjustable bus shunt records. Define the subsystem (see Section 2.3.2, Creating a Bus Subsystem). The values entered into the record are subsequently applied to all buses within the specified subsystem. Cells left blank, or set to No change, indicate that no changes are to be made to the present working case values. To add or modify a group of Adjustable Bus Shunt records, click the Add/modify for selected buses cell and choose one of the following options:
updates only existing adjustable bus shunt records where the bus number corresponds to a bus within the selected subsystem and the shunt identifier corresponds to the one specified in the Id cell. No new adjustable bus shunt records are added. (1) updates existing adjustable bus shunt records where the bus number corresponds to a bus within the selected subsystem and the shunt identifier corresponds to the one specified in the Id cell. (2) if an Adjustable Bus Shunt record does not already exist with the bus number and shunt identifier specified, a new Adjustable Bus Shunt record is added For example, if 2 is entered into the Id cell, then all adjustable bus shunt records whose buses reside within the specified subsystem and have a shunt identifier of 2 will be updated to reflect the new values defined. Buses within the subsystem that do not currently have a corresponding adjustable bus shunt record with a shunt identifier of 2 will have a new shunt record introduced into the working case.
Modify only
Add/Modify
Values for Susceptance and the Cost Scale coefficient may be entered directly in the cells provided. Cells left blank indicate that no changes are to be made to the current working case values of existing Adjustable Bus Shunt records, and that default values are to be applied to new records. The Susceptance and Cost Scale coefficient cells support use of the summation ( + ) and multiplication ( ) operator functions. These operators may be used to automatically adjust the maximum and/or minimum voltage magnitudes at all buses within the specified subsystem by either a constant or a scale factor. The In Service cell provides options for in-service and out-of-service as well as a No change option to retain the current settings. To delete a group of Adjustable Bus Shunt records, go to the Id cell in the subsystem and do one of the following steps: enter a shunt Id value, if only Adjustable Bus Shunt records with the specified shunt Id are to be deleted OR leave the shunt Id value blank, if all Adjustable Bus Shunt records within the subsystem are to be deleted.
Highlight the row and press [Delete]. The setting of the Add/modify for selected buses cell is ignored; either option will allow successful deletion of the specified group of records.
19-6
Figure 19-7. Example of Adjustable Branch Reactance Spreadsheet Only those branches that have Adjustable Branch Reactance data records defined in the working case are displayed in the spreadsheet. The list of records shown can be reduced by specifying a subsystem (see Section 2.3.2, Creating a Bus Subsystem). To add an Adjustable Branch Reactance record, either enter a valid From Bus, To Bus and branch Id in the cells provided, or double click in any of the Bus or Id cells and choose from a list of available branches in the [Branch Selection] dialog (Figure 7-19). Only nontransformer branches are valid for use in Adjustable Branch Reactance records. Values for the three Reactance Multipliers and the Cost Scale Coefficient may be entered directly in the cells provided. If desired, uncheck the In Service toggle switch to set the Adjustable Branch Reactance record to out-of-service. It is not possible to introduce new branches through the Adjustable Branch Reactance spreadsheet. Use the standard power flow branch spreadsheet and diagram tools to add a branch. If a branch is removed from the power flow network, the corresponding Adjustable Branch Reactance record is also removed.
Figure 19-8. Adjustable Branch Reactance Subsystem Spreadsheet To add and/or modify a group of Adjustable Branch Reactance records, define a subsystem and enter values in the first row of the spreadsheet. Values for the three Reactance Multipliers and the Cost Scale Coefficient may be entered directly in the cells provided. New Adjustable Branch Reactance data records will either be created or existing ones modified to the values specified in the table. Cells left blank, or set to No change, indicate that no changes are to be made to the present working case values, and that default values are to be used for new records.
19-7
The three Reactance Multipliers and the Cost Scale Coefficient cells support use of the summation ( + ) and multiplication ( ) operator functions. These operators may be used to automatically adjust the working case values of each Adjustable Branch Reactance record within the specified subsystem by either a constant or scale factor. The In Service cell provides options for in-service and out-of-service as well as a No change option to retain the current settings. To delete a group of Adjustable Branch Reactance records, define a subsystem, highlight the first row, and press [Delete].
Figure 19-9. Example of Branch Flow Spreadsheet By default all Branch Flow Constraint records within the working case are displayed in the spreadsheet. The list of records can be further reduced by specifying a subsystem (see Section 2.3.2, Creating a Bus Subsystem). To add an Branch Flow Constraint record, either enter a valid From Bus, To Bus, Last Bus (for a three-winding transformer), branch Id and Flow Id in the cells provided, or double click in any of the Bus or Id cells and choose from a list of available branches in the [Branch Selection] dialog (Figure 7-19). Non-transformer branches, two-winding transformers, and individual windings of three-winding transformers are valid for use in Branch Flow Constraint records. Unique flow identifiers must be used if more than one Branch Flow Constraint record is to exist for the same branch or transformer. If another row is clicked before a new flow identifier is entered, the Flow Id cell will be set to 1 and locked. Delete the record and re-enter it to reset the Id. Values for Normal or Emergency Flow Limits may be entered directly into the spreadsheet cells. The Initialize Rate Limits cell provides provides a menu from which one of four options may be selected:
None has no impact on the values specified in the Flow Limit Normal, Max or Flow Limit Normal, Min cells places the positive magnitude of the specified branch flow rating in the Flow Limit Normal, Max cell, and the negative magnitude of the specified branch flow rating in the Flow Limit Normal, Min cell The branch flow ratings are obtained directly from the values stored in the working case.
The Flow Type cell provides provides a menu from which one of four options may be selected: MW, MVAR, MVA, or ampere.
19-8
The Limit Type cell provides a menu from which one of the following options may be selected: Reporting Hard limit Soft-linear limit Soft-quadratic limit
A Soft Limit Penalty cell becomes active and the default value may be modified if either the Softlinear or Soft-quadratic limit type is selected in the Limit Type cell. Otherwise, this cell is locked. If a branch is removed from the power flow network, the corresponding Branch Flow Constraint record is also removed.
Figure 19-10. Branch Flow Subsystem Spreadsheet The Branch Flow Constraint Subsystem spreadsheet is particularly helpful in modifying and/or introducing a large number of branch flow constraints that have the same values. It can also be used to delete a group of adjustable branch flow constraints. Values entered in the input record apply to all Branch Flow records within a previously defined subsystem. For all branches in the defined subsystem, new Branch Flow Constraint records will either be created or existing records modified with the values specified in the table. Cells left blank will indicate that no changes are to be made to present working case values of existing records, and that default values are to be used for new records. To add or modify a group of Branch Flow records, click the Add/modify for selected branches cell and choose one of the following options: updates existing branch flow constraint records whose branch identifiers correspond to a branch within the selected subsystem and whose flow identifier corresponds to the one specified in the Flow Id cell. No new Branch Flow Constraint records are automatically added.
Modify only
19-9
Add/Modify
(1) updates existing branch flow constraint records where the branch identifiers correspond to a branch within the selected subsystem and the flow identifier corresponds to the one specified in the Flow Id cell (2) if a Branch Flow Constraint record does not already exist with the branch and flow identifiers specified, a new Branch Flow Constraint record will be added For example, if 2 is entered in the Flow Id cell, then all branch flow constraints whose corresponding branches reside within the specified subsystem and have a flow identifier of 2 will be updated to reflect the new values specified. Branches within the subsystem that do not currently have a corresponding branch flow constraint record with a flow identifier of 2 will have a new branch flow constraint automatically introduced into the working case.
Values for Normal or Emergency Flow Limits may be entered directly into the spreadsheet cells. The Flow Limits cells support use of the summation ( + ) and multiplication ( ) operator functions. These operators may be used to automatically adjust the values for all branch flow constraints within the selected subsystem by either a constant or a scale factor. The Initialize Rate Limits cell provides provides a menu from which one of four options may be selected:
None has no impact on the values specified in the Flow Limit Normal, Max or Flow Limit Normal, Min cells places the positive magnitude of the specified branch flow rating in the Flow Limit Normal, Max cell, and the negative magnitude of the specified branch flow rating in the Flow Limit Normal, Min cell The branch flow ratings are obtained directly from the values stored in the working case.
The Flow Type cell provides provides a menu from which one of five options may be selected: MW, MVAR, MVA, ampere, or no change. The Limit Type cell provides a menu from which one of the following options may be selected: No change Reporting Hard limit Soft-linear limit Soft-quadratic limit
A Soft Limit Penalty cell becomes active and the default value may be modified if either the Softlinear or Soft-quadratic limit type is selected in the Limit Type cell. Otherwise, this cell is locked. To delete a group of Branch Flow Constraint records, go to the Flow Id cell in the subsystem and do one of the following steps:
19-10
enter a Flow Id value, if only Branch Flow Constraint records with the specified Flow Id are to be deleted OR
leave the Flow Id value blank, if all Branch Flow Constraint records within the subsystem are to be deleted.
Highlight the row and press [Delete]. The setting of the Add/modify for selected buses cell is ignored; either option will allow successful deletion of the specified group of records.
Figure 19-11. Example of Adjustable Bus Load Spreadsheet By default all bus loads in the working case are displayed in the Adjustable Bus Load spreadsheet. A reduced set of loads can be displayed by specifying a subsystem (see Section 2.3.2, Creating a Bus Subsystem). Adjustable Bus Load records that have not been previously modified will display a default value of zero in the Adjustable Bus Load Table cell. The Bus Number, Bus Name and Id cells are used for identification of the bus load and cannot be edited. To modify a reference to an Adjustable Bus Load table, either enter the desired value directly into the Adjustable Bus Load Table cell, or double click in the cell and choose from a list of available adjustable bus load tables in the [Adjustable Bus Load Table Selection] dialog. If an invalid table number is entered, a warning is displayed and the original value is replaced in the cell. To delete a reference to an Adjustable Bus Load table, either reset the value in the cell to zero or highlight the row and press [Delete]. If a bus load is removed from the power flow network, the corresponding Adjustable Bus Load record will also be removed.
19-11
Figure 19-12. Adjustable Bus Load Subsystem Spreadsheet Usage of the Adjustable Bus Load Subsystem spreadsheet is particularly helpful in specifying that multiple loads should all point to the same Adjustable Bus Load Table. Values entered in the input record are applied to all Adjustable Bus Loads within a previously defined subsystem. To modify a reference to an Adjustable Bus Load table, either enter the desired value directly into the Adjustable Bus Load Table cell, or double click in the cell and choose from a list of available adjustable bus load tables in the [Adjustable Bus Load Table Selection] dialog. If an invalid table number is entered, a warning is displayed and a zero is replaced in the cell. To reset the Adjustable Bus Load table to zero for all OPF Bus Loads in the specified subsystem, either reset the value in the cell to zero or highlight the row and press [Delete].
19-12
Figure 19-13. Example of Adjustable Load Table Spreadsheet All Adjustable Load Tables within the working case are displayed. The subsystem filter has no affect on the editor. If there are no Adjustable Load Tables in the working case, the spreadsheet will be blank. To add a new Adjustable Load Table record, enter the desired table number in the Table cell of the row containing the . All other cells are populated with default data values. Values for the three load multipliers (initial, maximum, and minimum) and Cost Scale may be entered directly into the spreadsheet cells. If desired, uncheck the In Service toggle switch to set the Adjustable Load Table record to out-ofservice. To delete an Adjustable Load Table record, highlight the row and press [Delete]. If the Adjustable Load Table record is not being referenced by any Adjustable Bus Load records, then it is deleted. If it is still being referenced by an Adjustable Bus Load record, a message pops up and the record is preserved.
Figure 19-14. Example of Generator Dispatch Spreadsheet By default all machines in the working case are displayed in the Generator Dispatch spreadsheet. A reduced set of machines may be displayed by specifying a subsystem (see Section 2.3.2, Creating a Bus Subsystem). Generator Dispatch records that have not been previously modified will display default values of zero.
19-13
The Bus Number, Bus Name and Id cells are used for identification of the machine and cannot be edited. To modify the Dispatch cell, enter the desired value in the cell. To modify a Dispatch Table number, either enter the desired value directly into the cell, or double click in the cell and choose from a list of available active power dispatch tables in the [Active Dispatch Selection] dialog. If an invalid table number is entered, a warning is displayed and the original value is replaced in the cell. A valid Adjustable Dispatch Table record must exist before it can be referenced by a Generator Dispatch record. To remove a reference to a Dispatch table and reset the Dispatch Table value to zero, either enter a zero in the cell or highlight the row and press [Delete]. If a machine is removed from the load flow network, the corresponding Generator Dispatch record will also be removed.
Figure 19-15. Generator Dispatch Subsystem Spreadsheet The Generator Dispatch Subsystem spreadsheet is used to define the same Dispatch value and/or Dispatch Table number for all machines within a specified subsystem. To modify a group of Generation Dispatch records, define a subsystem and enter values in the first row of the spreadsheet. Value for Dispatch may be entered directly into the spreadsheet cell. This cell supports use of the summation ( + ) and multiplication ( ) operator functions. These operators may be used to automatically adjust the dispatch fraction at all generators within the specified subsystem by either a constant or a scale factor. The modify the Dispatch Table number, either directly enter the table number in the cell provided or double click in the cell and choose from a list of available active power dispatch tables in the [Active Dispatch Selection] dialog. If an invalid table number is entered, a warning is displayed and the original value is replaced in the cell. The Dispatch Table number -1 implies that current Dispatch Table values for all Generator Dispatch records in the selected subsystem should be preserved. This allows the Dispatch value to be modified independent of the Dispatch table.
19-14
To reset the values for all Generator Dispatch records in the selected subsystem, either enter a zero in the cell or highlight the row and press [Delete].
Figure 19-16. Example of Active Power Dispatch Table Spreadsheet All Active Power Dispatch Tables within the working case are always shown in the editor. The subsystem filter has no effect on the list displayed. If no Active Power Dispatch Tables exist in the working case, the spreadsheet is blank. To add a new Active Power Dispatch Table record, enter the desired table number in the Table cell of the row containing the . All other cells are populated with default data values. Values for Generation Max, Generation Min, and Fuel Cost Scale Coefficient may be entered directly into the spreadsheet cells. The Cost Curve Type cell provides a provides a menu from which one of the following options may be selected: Polynomial & Exponential Piece-wise linear Piece-wise quadratic
To modify a Cost Table number, either enter the desired value directly into the cell, or double click in the cell and choose from a list of available piece-wise linear tables in the [Cost Table Selection] dialog. If an invalid table number is entered, a warning is displayed and the original value is replaced in the cell. If desired, uncheck the In Service toggle switch to set the Active Power Dispatch Table record to out-of-service. To delete an Active Power Dispatch Table record, highlight the row and press [Delete]. If the Active Power Dispatch Table record is not being referenced by any Generator Dispatch records, then it is deleted; otherwise a message is produced and the record is preserved.
19-15
Figure 19-17. Example of Generation Reactive Capability Spreadsheet Only those machines that have Generation Reactive Capability data records defined in the working case are displayed in the spreadsheet. The list of records can be further reduced by specifying a subsystem (see Section 2.3.2, Creating a Bus Subsystem). To add a Generation Reactive Capability record, either enter a valid Bus Number and machine Id in the cells provided or double click in the blank Bus Number cell and choose from a list of available machines in the [Machine Selection] dialog (Figure 20-11). All other cells are populated with default data values. Values for Xd, Stator Current Limit, Lagging Power Factor, Leading Power Factor, and Maximum Qgen Absorption may be entered directly into the spreadsheet cells. The Reactive Capability Limit cell provides a provides a menu from which one of the following status options may be selected: Out-of-service Enables + Delta Efd inhibit - Delta Efd inhibit Fixed Efd
To delete an Generation Reactive Capability record, highlight the row and press [Delete]. If a machine is removed from the power flow network, the corresponding Generation Reactive Capability record will also be removed.
19-16
To modify a group of Generation Reactive Capability records within a subsystem, define a subsystem and enter values in the first row of the spreadsheet. Values for Xd, Stator Current Limit, Lagging Power Factor, Leading Power Factor, and Maximum Qgen Absorption may be entered directly into the spreadsheet cells. The values entered into the record are subsequently applied to all machines within the specified subsystem. Cells left blank, or set to No change, indicate that no changes are to be made to the present working case values. The data input cells support use of the summation ( + ) and multiplication ( ) operator functions. These operators may be used to automatically adjust the working case values of each Generation Reactive Capability record within the specified subsystem by either a constant or a scale factor. The Reactive Capability Limit cell provides a provides a menu from which one of the following status options may be selected: No change Out-of-service Enables + Delta Efd inhibit - Delta Efd inhibit Fixed Efd
To delete a group of Generation Reactive Capability records, define a subsystem, highlight the first row, and press [Delete].
Figure 19-19. Example of Generation Reserve Spreadsheet Only those machines that have Generation Reserve data records defined are displayed in the editor. The list of records shown can be further reduced by specifying a subsystem (see Section 2.3.2, Creating a Bus Subsystem). To add a Generation Reserve record, either enter a valid Bus Number and machine Id in the cells provided or double click in the blank Bus Number cell and choose from a list of available machines in the [Machine Selection] dialog (Figure 20-11). All other cells are populated with default data values. Values for Unit Ramp Rate and Unit Capability may be entered directly into the spreadsheet cells. To delete an Generation Reserve record, highlight the row and press [Delete].
19-17
If a machine is removed from the power flow network, the corresponding Generation Reserve record is also removed.
Figure 19-20. Generation Reserve Subsystem Spreadsheet To modify a group of Generation Reserve records, define a subsystem and enter values in the first row of the spreadsheet. Values for Unit Ramp Rate and Unit Capability may be entered directly into the spreadsheet cells. The values entered into the record are subsequently applied to all buses within the specified subsystem. Cells left blank indicate that no changes are to be made to the present working case values and that default values are to be applied to new records. The Unit Ramp Rate and Unit Capability cells support use of the summation ( + ) and multiplication ( ) operator functions. These operators may be used to automatically adjust the working case values for each Generation Reserve record within the specified subsystem by either a constant or a scale factor. To delete a group of Generation Reserve records, define a subsystem, highlight the first row, and press [Delete].
19-18
The [OPF - Change Parameters] dialog provides a number of checkboxes to enable specific functions and filters to establish specified tolerances and controls. These are grouped by function on dialog tabs. The user may restore default values using one of the following options: Restore system default settings Restore working case settings
19-19
19.3.1 General
The [OPF - Change Parameters] General tab (Figure 19-21) provides checkboxes to enable various functions. If the parameters are to be saved to the options file, select the save settings to PSSOPF.OPT file checkbox. Click [OK] to employ the new parameters when analyzing the working case.
19-20
19.3.2 Objectives
The [OPF - Change Parameters] Objectives tab provides checkboxes to enable various functions. Some of them permit changes to cut-off values (defaults are shown in Figure 19-22). If the parameters are to be saved to the options file, select the save settings to PSSOPF.OPT file checkbox. Click [OK] to employ the new parameters when analyzing the working case.
19-21
19.3.3 Tolerances
The [OPF - Change Parameters] Tolerances tab provides cut-off values for various values (defaults are shown in Figure 19-23) that may be changed. If the parameters are to be saved to the options file, select the save settings to PSSOPF.OPT file checkbox. Click [OK] to employ the new parameters when analyzing the working case.
19-22
19.3.4 Control
The [OPF - Change Parameters] Control tab provides checkboxes to enable various functions. Some of them permit changes to cut-off values (defaults are shown in Figure 19-24). If the parameters are to be saved to the options file, select the save settings to PSSOPF.OPT file checkbox. Click [OK] to employ the new parameters when analyzing the working case.
19-23
19.3.5 Reporting
The [OPF - Change Parameters] Reporting tab (Figure 19-25) provides checkboxes to enable various functions. Click [ ] to open the selection window to save optimization data in a Log file (*.log), which can be a new file or a previously-built file to be over-written. The report may be specified by bus subsystem. If the parameters are to be saved to the options file, select the save settings to PSSOPF.OPT file checkbox. Click [OK] to employ the new parameters when analyzing the working case.
Figure 19-25. OPF - Change Parameters Dialog, Reporting The Optimization Log is a text file that can be read in any text editor. It can be specified in standard (Figure 19-26) or detailed (Figure 19-27) format.
19-24
19-25
19-26
The [OPF Solution] dialog (Figure 19-28) provides access to [OPF - Change Parameters] and permits the report to be specified by bus subsystem. These options over-ride previously loaded settings from either the PSSOPF.OPT file or any changes made earlier in a work session using [OPF - Change Parameters]. Click [Go] to create the report. A summary of activity conditions is displayed in the Progress tab (Figure 19-29). The report is displayed in the Report tab by default. The content and number of pages of the report are dependent upon the specified objectives and other options.
19-27
19-28
The [List Data] dialog (Figure 8-1) provides options for listing the following data types in either pu or kV Output voltage.
Case summary All data Active power dispatch tables Adjustable bus loads Adjustable bus load tables Adjustable branch reactance Branch flow constraint Bus Bus shunt Generator dispatch Generation reactive capability Generation reserve Interface flow constraint Linear constraint Period reserve constraint Piece-wise linear cost table Piece-wise quadratic cost table Polynomial and exponential cost table Two-terminal DC lines
The report may be specified by bus subsystem. Click [Go] to create the report, which is displayed in the Report tab by default You will need to click [Close] to end this activity.
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
19-29
The [OPF Data Tables] dialog holds tabs that display six different data records. Examples of the records are provided in the following sections: Linear Cost Tables: Section 19.6.1 Quadratic Cost Tables: Section 19.6.2 Polynomial and Exponential Cost Tables: Section 19.6.3 Period Reserve Constraints: Section 19.6.4 Interface Flow Constraints: Section 19.6.5 Linear Constraint Dependencies: Section 19.6.6
19-30
19-31
19-32
19-33
19-34
19-35
19-36
If there are no linear constraint records in the working case, the Linear Constraints window will be empty. To display the information contained in the record, highlight it (see Figure 19-37). To create a new record, enter the next available Number, specify values for the appropriate fields, and click [Add]. To modify an existing record, highlight it, change its values, and click [Modify]. To define another parameters record, highlight the record, specify values for the appropriate fields, and click [Add]. To remove a record or parameter record, highlight the item and click [Delete] on your keyboard.
19-37
Optimal Power Flow Creating an Optimal Power Flow Raw Data File
The [Save Network Data] dialog provides a tab (Figure 19-38) that allows specification of the data content for an Optimal Power Flow Data file (*.rop). Click [ ] to open the selection window to specify the filename; this can be a new file or a previously-built file to be over-written. Click [OK] to save the file.
19-38
Optimal Power Flow Creating an Optimal Power Flow Raw Data File
Figure 19-38. Save Network Data Dialog, Optimal Power Flow Data
19-39
Optimal Power Flow Creating an Optimal Power Flow Raw Data File
19-40
Chapter 20
Dynamic Simulation Data Entry and Modification
20.1 Reading Dynamics Model Data
Activity DYRE
Requirements / Prerequisites Validly specified power flow case, solved to an acceptable mismatch level.
Scroll Files of Type: to select Dynamics Model Raw Data file (*.dyr). Highlight the desired file and click [Open]. The [Read Raw Format Dynamics Data] dialog (Figure 20-1) requires specification of CONEC/CONET FLECS files (*.flx) and a CONEC/CONET Compile file (*.bat) for some dynamics model applications. Provide these filenames as appropriate for your simulation. Modified starting values for CONs, ICONs, STATEs and VARs may be specified. Click [OK]. PSSE reads the specified file and updates [Dynamics Tree] and [Spreadsheet] with the Dynamics data contained in the file. A summary is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 20-2).
20-1
Dynamic Simulation Data Entry and Modification Reading Dynamics Model Data
Figure 20-2. Example of Read Raw Format Dynamics Data Summary Output
20-2
Dynamic Simulation Data Entry and Modification Reading Dynamics Model Data
Scroll Files of Type: to select Add Dynamics Model Data (*.dyr). Highlight the desired file and click [Open]. The [Read Raw Format Dynamics Data (Adding to existing data)] dialog (Figure 20-3) requires specification of CONEC/CONET FLECS files (*.flx) and a CONEC/CONET Compile file (*.bat) for some dynamics model applications. Provide these filenames as appropriate for your simulation. Starting values for CONs, ICONs, STATEs and VARs reflect the data already populating the working case. These may be modified. Click [OK]. PSSE reads the specified file and updates [Dynamics Tree] and [Spreadsheet] with the Dynamics data contained in the file. A summary is routed to the Progress tab.
Figure 20-3. Read Raw Format Dynamics Data Dialog when Adding Data
20-3
Dynamic Simulation Data Entry and Modification Restoring Dynamics Working Memory from a Binary Snapshot File
From the [Open] file selector window, select Dynamics Snapshot Data File (*.snp). Highlight the desired file and click [Open]. The file will populate the dynamics spreadsheets.
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
Section 14.4, Restoring Dynamics Working Memory from a Binary Snapshot File
20-4
Dynamic Simulation Data Entry and Modification Restoring Dynamics Working Memory from a Binary Snapshot File Created in
20.3 Restoring Dynamics Working Memory from a Binary Snapshot File Created in PSSE-26 or Earlier
Activity SRRS
Requirements / Prerequisites Validly specified power flow case, solved to an acceptable mismatch level.
From the [Open] file selector window, select Dynamics Snapshot Raw Data File (*.srs). Highlight the desired file and click [Open]. The file will populate the dynamics spreadsheets.
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
Section 14.5, Restoring Dynamics Working Memory from a Snapshot File Created in PSSE-26 or Earlier
20-5
The [Channel Setup Wizard] dialog (Figure 20-4) provides checkboxes to route specified dynamics quantities to plot channels. Click [ ] to open the selection window to specify a Channel Output file (*.out) to retain channel data. This can be a new file or a previously-built file to be overwritten. The Machine option in Categories to Output provides a pull-down list where pre-selected groups of machine quantities may be specified. Wind Machine, Load, Bus, and Branch quantities may be specified as the entire group of quantities. Quantities may also be specified individually for all categories. Click [Finish] to save channel specifications. A summary is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 205).
20-6
Section 14.2, Assigning Simulation Variables to Output Channels Table 14-2 and Table 18-1 for parameter definitions
20-7
This activity assigns simulation variables to output channels, grouping the variables in the following categories: Bus Quantity Line Quantity Load Quantity Machine Quantity Miscellaneous Quantity
20-8
Bus Quantity
The [Assign Channels for Bus Quantities] dialog (Figure 20-6) provides channel assignment for individual bus quantities of Frequency, Voltage, or Voltage and angle. The user creates channel identifier(s) for specific simulations. Click [Select] to display [Bus Selection] where the desired bus may be specified. Click [Go] to assign the channel output. A summary is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 20-7). [Dynamics Tree] displays an index of the channels as they are built (Figure 208).
20-9
20-10
Line Quantity
The [Assign Channels for Line Quantities] dialog (Figure 20-9) provides channel assignment for individual line quantities of Flow (P), Flow (PQ), Flow (MVA), or Relay2 (R&X). The user creates channel identifier(s) for specific simulations. Click [Select] to display [Branch Selection] where the desired buses may be specified. Click [Go] to assign the channel output. A summary is routed to the Progress tab. [Dynamics Tree] displays an index of the channels as they are built (Figure 208).
20-11
Load Quantity
The [Assign Channels for Load Quantities] dialog (Figure 20-10) provides channel assignment for individual load quantities of Pload or Qload. The user creates channel identifier(s) for specific simulations. Click [Select] to display [Load Selection] where the from bus and load may be specified. Click [Go] to assign the channel output. A summary is routed to the Progress tab. [Dynamics Tree] displays an index of the channels as they are built (Figure 20-8).
20-12
Machine Quantity
The [Assign Channels for Machine Quantities] dialog (Figure 20-12) provides channel assignment for individual machine quantities of any of the following data:
Angle Pelec Qelec Eterm EFD Pmech Speed Xadifd Ecomp Vothsg Vref Vuel Voel Gref Lcref
The user creates channel identifier(s) for specific simulations. Click [Select] to display [Machine Selection] where the From bus and Machine ID may be specified (Figure 20-11). Click [OK] to return to [Assign Channels for Machine Quantities].
20-13
Click [Go] to assign the channel output. A summary is routed to the Progress tab. [Dynamics Tree] displays an index of the channels as they are built (Figure 20-8).
20-14
Miscellaneous Quantity
The [Assign Channels for Miscellaneous Quantities] dialog (Figure 20-13) provides channel assignment for individual VARs or STATEs. The user creates channel identifier(s) for specific simulations. Click [Go] to assign the channel output. A summary is routed to the Progress tab. [Dynamics Tree] displays an index of the channels as they are built (Figure 20-8).
20-15
The [Select Channels by Subsystem] dialog (Figure 20-14) permits channel assignment for all elements defined by a bus subsystem. Simulation variables that are monitored during the Dynamic simulation are selected for recording. The dialog contains tabs that support channel assignment of the following types of data: Tie line quantities: Flow (P) Flow (P&Q) Flow (MVA) Relay2 (R&X)
Selection by Area or Zone; can include out-of-service equipment. Machine, bus, load, and branch quantities:
Angle Pelec Qelec Eterm EFD Pmech Speed Xadifd Ecomp Vothsg Vref BsFreq Voltage Volt & Ang Flow (P) Flow (P&Q) Flow (MVA) Relay2 (R&X) Mach Item Mach App Imp Vuel Voel Pload Qload Gref Lcref Wvlcty Wtrbsp Wpitch Waerot Wrotrv Wrotri Wpcmnd Wqcmnd Wauxsg
Selection by Bus subsystem; can include out-of-service equipment. Subsystem power totals: selection by Area, Zone, Owner, or All Buses Machine angle statistics
Click [Go] to assign the channel output. A summary is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 20-15).
20-16
20-17
20-18
Dynamic Simulation Data Entry and Modification Saving Dynamics Working Memory in a Binary FIle
The snapshot activity SNAP preserves the contents of dynamics working memory in a user specified Dynamics Snapshot Data File (*.snp). The Snapshot Data tab of the [Save / Show Dynamics Data] dialog (Figure 20-16) requires a Destination filename, which may overwrite an existing file using the selection window or be entered directly to create a new file.
Figure 20-16. Save / Show Dynamics Snapshot Data Dialog Output quantities describes the number of elements in the CON, STATE, VAR and ICON arrays and the number of output channels specified in the working case. The defaults may be changed, but should be at least as large as the number of elements in use in the corresponding data arrays. Click [OK] to save the data. The following message is displayed in the Progress tab. SNAPSHOT STORED IN FILE C:\\<filename>.snp AT TIME =
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
0.000
20-19
Selecting the Dynamic Snapshots option from [File Information] produces a report of dynamic snapshots filenames in the current working directory.
20-20
Dynamic Simulation Data Entry and Modification Modifying Data in Dynamics Working Memory
Spreadsheet View The [Dynamics Spreadsheet] is used to add, remove, edit, and change the status of models attached to network components (see Figure 20-18). It is formatted with tabs. Formatting the spreadsheet and modifying the data is described in Section 2.2, Editing and Formatting the Spreadsheet.
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
Section 14.6, Modifying Data in Dynamics Working Memory PSSE Program Operation Manual, Section 18.6, Simulation Outputs
20-21
Dynamic Simulation Data Entry and Modification Modifying Data in Dynamics Working Memory
20-22
Dynamic Simulation Data Entry and Modification Modifying Dynamics Model Pointer Tables
The [Model Maintenance] dialog provides maintenance functions for unconnected models and user-defined models. In addition, consistency checks are available for Plant and Wind models. List unconnected models: lists all models of the selected type that are not connected to any network elements Remove unconnected models: removes all models of the selected type that are not connected to any network elements. They will no longer appear in any saved Snapshot or DYRE files. Pack models: packs the internal storage tables and removes holes (i.e., entries that are marked as unused) from the model connection table and the array allocation table for all models of the selected type. If these tables are packed, messages are printed at the Progress tab. List user models: lists all user models of the selected type found in the active User Dynamics Dll. Remove unused user models: deletes any model definitions of the selected type that are not referenced from the array allocation table from the user model definition table. Vacated slots are available for new model definitions. Consistency check: performs an internal consistency check that loops through all machines in the working case and displays an alarm message for any invalid model combinations. Select the desired model type and click the maintenance function from the Select and run list. The Progress tab displays an appropriate message, for example: ALL LINE RELAY MODELS ARE CONNECTED TO POWER FLOW BRANCHES NO USER MODEL LOAD-TYPE DEFINITIONS IN TABLES CONSISTENCY CHECK OK FOR PLANT MODELS
20-23
Dynamic Simulation Data Entry and Modification Modifying Dynamics Model Pointer Tables
Figure 20-19. Model Maintenance Dialog You will need to click [Close] to end this activity.
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
20-24
Dynamic Simulation Data Entry and Modification Creating a Dynamics Model Raw Data File
Activity DYDA replicates dynamics model data in the working case in a file that can be read by activity DYRE (Section 20.1). The Dynamics Model Data tab of the [Save / Show Dynamics Data] dialog (Figure 20-20) requires a Destination: the Report window or a filename, which may be selected from existing files using the selection window or be entered directly to create a new file.
20-25
Dynamic Simulation Data Entry and Modification Creating a Dynamics Model Raw Data File
The data output can be listed by subsystem, or all subroutine CONEC or CONET models can be replicated. If the output selected is Models by subsystem, the list may include all models or be limited by model type as follows:
All models All plant models Generator models Compensator models Stabilizer models Minimum exciter limiter models Maximum exciter limiter models Excitation system models Turbine governor models Load characteristic models Load relay models Line relay models Auxiliary signal models 2-Terminal dc models N-Terminal dc models VSC dc models FACTS device models Turbine load controller models Switched shunt models Wind models Wind generator models Wind electrical control models Wind mechanical models Wind pitch models Wind aerodynamic models Wind gust models Wind auxiliary control models CONEC models CONET models
If either Load characteristic models or Load relay models are selected to be processed for a Selected bus subsystem, Load model output may also be specified. Click [OK] to save or report the data. If a filename has been specified, the message OUTPUT COMPLETED is displayed on the Progress tab and a summary of model CONS is generated on the Report tab.
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
20-26
Dynamic Simulation Data Entry and Modification Creating Dynamic Data Records for Use by Other Activities
The auxiliary dynamics data output activity replicates machine parametric data from dynamics working memory in the following formats: Inertia and Governor Response Data File for input to activity INLF Breaker Duty Data File for input to activity BKDY Line relay data and branch impedances in the form required by the PSSPLT activity RELY
The Machine Parametric Source Data tab of the [Save / Show Dynamics Data] dialog (Figure 2021) requires a Destination filename, which may overwrite an existing file using the selection window or be entered directly to create a new file.
Figure 20-21. Save / Show Machine Parametric Source Data Dialog The user must specify a Data file format. If the Inertia and Governor response file format is selected, additional specifications may be made.
20-27
Dynamic Simulation Data Entry and Modification Creating Dynamic Data Records for Use by Other Activities
Section 14.20, Creating Dynamic Data Records for Use by Other Activities
20-28
This activity generates reports or checks dynamics data for equipment models of specified categories of models. The [List Dynamics Model Data] dialog (Figure 20-22) requires the user to select the operating mode, list format, and model type to be processed. The report may be specified by bus subsystem. Click [Go] to create the report, which is displayed in the Report tab by default (Figure 20-23).
Figure 20-22. List Dynamics Model Data Dialog You will need to click [Close] to end this activity.
20-29
20-30
This activity generates reports listing principle dynamics data arrays, within defined index ranges. The [List Dynamics Data Common] dialog (Figure 20-24) provides checkboxes to specify the type of data contained in the list and field boxes to limit the range reported. Click [Reset] to restore the values that reflect the number of elements being used in the current simulation. Click [OK] to create the report, which is displayed in the Report tab by default (Figure 20-25).
20-31
20-32
This activity generates reports listing the storage locations, by model category, associated with table-driven models referenced in the users simulation setup. These locations store CON, STATE, VAR, and ICON data. The [List Model Storage Locations] dialog (Figure 20-26) provides tabs that specify reports for the following model types:
Machines Loads Wind Machines Relays Auxiliary Signals FACTS Devices Switched Shunts DC Lines
All reports require specification of model status. Some reports may be limited to specific model types; for example, the option All wind machines or only Mechanical wind machines may be selected. Each report may be specified by bus subsystem. Click [Go] to create the report, which is displayed in the Report tab by default (Figure 20-26). You will need to click [Close] to end this activity.
20-33
20-34
Dynamic Simulation Data Entry and Modification Dumping Dynamic Simulation Output Channels into a Response File
The output channel dumping activity DMPC replicates dynamic simulation output channels contained in dynamics working memory in a PSSE Response file. The Dump Output Channels tab of the [Save / Show Dynamics Data] dialog (Figure 20-28) requires a Destination filename, which may overwrite an existing file using the selection window or be entered directly to create a new file.
Figure 20-28. Save / Show Dump Output Channels Dialog The user must specify channel preference for all channels or omitting channels containing VARs and STATEs. Click [OK] to save or report the data.
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
Section 14.19, Dumping Dynamic Simulation Output Channels into a Response File
20-35
Dynamic Simulation Data Entry and Modification Defining Model Search Paths
The use of external formats to support Dynamics models was first made available in Version 30.3 with the Graphical Model Builder (GMB). The GMB uses a Visio-based interface to graphically create Dynamics equipment models. These GMB models can then be attached to network equipment in the same manner as PSSE standard models and user-written and compiled models. Since the GMB models are defined in external files, the application must be made aware of the location of these files. The [Define Model File Search Paths] dialog (Figure 20-29) allows the user to define specific directories in which the program can search to find required data-driven files.
Figure 20-29. Define Model Search Paths The initial default directory is the current directory (.\). Click the New (Insert) button to add a new directory to the search list. A blank line will be displayed. Click [ ] to open the [Select Directory] dialog (see Figure 20-30).
20-36
Dynamic Simulation Data Entry and Modification Defining Model Search Paths
Figure 20-30. Add a New Directory to the Search List Select a file directory to be searched and press OK. The new filepath will be added to the search list, as seen in Figure 20-31.
Figure 20-31. New Search Item Additional directories may be added, deleted or moved up and down in the search list by using the buttons at the top of the dialog. When the application is closed, the defined paths will be saved in a file named DynModelPaths.prm found in the Document and Settings directory for the active user. A total of five model search paths may be defined. Directories are searched for GMB models in the order in which they appear in the dialog shown in Figure 20-31. To change the search order, select an item file item in the dialog and move it up or down in the search order by use of the arrow icons found on the dialog.
20-37
20-38
Chapter 21
Dynamic Simulation Solutions
21.1 Dynamic Solution Parameters
Requirements / Prerequisites Validly specified power flow case, solved to an acceptable mismatch level. Dynamics data must exist in dynamics working memory.
Dynamics solution parameters are set and modified using the [Dynamic Solution Parameters] dialog (Figure 21-1). A number of controls affecting network solutions in dynamic simulations as well as the dynamic simulation itself can be set, and the channel output file can also be specified. Typically a dynamic simulation is run to a certain time, solution parameters are modified, and the run continued with the new parameters. Click [OK] to keep modified settings.
21-1
21-2
System-wide monitoring and solution options are set and modified using the [Dynamic Simulation Options] dialog (Figure 21-2). Checkboxes are available to enable/disable the following modeling options:
Network frequency dependence If enabled, both network parameters and the flux calculations of generator models are made dependent on local frequency. If enabled, every circuit in both directions checked for out-of-step conditions.
(NETFRQ)
Scan for out-of-step conditions
(OSSCAN)
Scan for generators exceeding angle threshold If enabled, trip machines instantaneously if the specified threshold is violated. Scan for generators exceeding power unbalance threshold
relay characteristics.
reported.
If enabled, machine angles, as well as any output channels containing machine angles, are expressed relative to the specified value rather than as absolute angles. This option applies to the Machine Angle Monitoring Model (SYSANG) in CHSB.
21-3
21-4
Reading Power Flow Raw Data into the Working Case OR Retrieving a Power Flow Saved Case File
Dynamics data must exist in dynamics working memory.
Restoring Dynamics Working Memory from a Binary Snapshot File OR Restoring Dynamics Working Memory from a Binary Snapshot File Created in PSSE-26 or Earlier
------
The [Perform Dynamic Simulation] dialog (Figure 21-3) provides Simulation options and a checkbox to enable the display of the network convergence monitor. Click [ ] to open the selection window for the required Channel Output file (*.out), which can be a new file or a previously-built file to be over-written. [Perform Dynamic Simulation] is a modeless dialog; you may access other program functions while it is active. Click [Initialize] to verify that initial conditions meet the criteria for simulation. A summary of initial conditions and suspect states, if any, is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 21-4), and the [Run] button is enabled. Click [Run] to perform the simulation. If the display of the network convergence monitor has been enabled, it is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 21-5). Otherwise, only the file path of the Channel Output file is displayed. After the simulation has been run to the specified time, disturbances and faults can be applied and the simulation run again to a new specified time (see Section 21.7, Applying Disturbances).
21-5
21-6
Initializing Models for State-Space Simulation Section 14.10, Performing State-Space Simulation in Time Steps
21-7
Excitation system testing, run to any point in time, is specified using the [Perform Exciter Simulation Test] dialog (Figure 21-6). Click [ ] to open the selection window for the required Channel Output file (*.out), which can be a new file or a previously-built file to be over-written. Click [Select] to display [Bus Selection] where the desired bus may be specified. If a bus is specified, the simulation tests the excitation system response of all connected machines having exciter models. If no bus is specified, the simulation tests all machines with connected exciter models. Specify the step to be applied at all voltage regulator setpoints in the VREF pu step change field, typically 0.02 to 0.1. The step magnitude should not exceed about ten percent (0.1) since the object of this test is to reveal small disturbance behavior. Also specify Simulation options. Click [Initialize]; a summary of initial conditions is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 21-7), and the [Run] button is enabled. Click [Run] to perform the simulation. A summary is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 21-8). After the simulation has been run to the specified time, disturbances and faults can be applied and the simulation run again to a new specified time (see Section 21.7, Applying Disturbances). [Perform Exciter Simulation Test] is a modeless dialog; you may access other program functions while it is active.
21-8
21-9
Dynamics > Simulation > Perform exciter response ratio simulation (ESTR/ERUN)
Excitation system response ratio testing, run to any point in time, is specified using the [Perform Exciter Response Ratio Simulation Test] dialog (Figure 21-9). Click [ ] to open the selection window for the required Channel Output file (*.out), which can be a new file or a previously-built file to be over-written. Click [Select] to display [Bus Selection] where the desired bus may be specified. If a bus is specified, the simulation tests the excitation system response of all connected machines having exciter models. If no bus is specified, the simulation tests all machines with connected exciter models. Specify the value used to initialize each generator to rated MVA (i.e., to MBASE as contained in the power flow generator data) in the Default power factor field. Also specify Simulation options. If you wish to initialize machines with a power factor other than the Default power factor, list them in the window under Machines initialized with own power factor. Click [Select] to display [Machine Selection] where the Bus and Machine ID may be selected. Adjust the Power factor and click [Add]. To remove a machine from the list, highlight it and press the [Delete] key on your keyboard. Click [Initialize]; a summary of initial conditions is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 21-9), and the [Run] button is enabled.
21-10
Click [Run] to perform the simulation. A summary is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 21-9). After the simulation has been run to the specified time, disturbances and faults can be applied and the simulation run again to a new specified time (see Section 21.7, Applying Disturbances). [Perform Exciter Response Ratio Simulation Test] is a modeless dialog; you may access other program functions while it is active.
21-11
Additional Information
PSSE Program Operation Manual, Section 14.11, Initializing Excitation System Models Section 14.12, Performing Exciter Simulation in Time Steps
21-12
Governor response testing, run to any point in time, is specified using the [Perform Governor Response Simulation] dialog (Figure 21-12). Click [ ] to open the selection window for the required Channel Output file (*.out), which can be a new file or a previously-built file to be over-written. Click [Select] to display [Bus Selection] where the desired bus may be specified. If a generating bus is specified, the simulation tests the governor response of all connected machines having governor models. If no bus is specified, the simulation tests all machines in the Snapshot file with connected governor models. The test is performed with each machine in isolation with a load. Specify the initial machine loading in per unit of machine base, MBASE in the Initial pu loading field. Specify the load step change to be applied at TIME equals zero during the simulation in the pu loading step field. This test assumes that generator and governor model parameters are entered on actual machine base. Also specify Simulation options. Click [Initialize]; a summary of initial conditions is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 21-13), and the [Run] button is enabled. Click [Run] to perform the simulation. A summary is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 21-14). After the simulation has been run to the specified time, disturbances and faults can be applied and the simulation run again to a new specified time (see Section 21.7, Applying Disturbances). [Perform Governor Response Simulation] is a modeless dialog; you may access other program functions while it is active.
21-13
21-14
Section 14.13, Initializing Turbine Governor Models Section 14.14, Performing Governor Response Simulation in Time Steps
21-15
The [Perform Extended Term Simulation] dialog (Figure 21-15) provides Simulation options and a checkbox to enable the display of the network convergence monitor. Click [ ] to open the selection window for the required Channel Output file (*.out), which can be a new file or a previously-built file to be over-written. [Perform Extended Term Simulation] is a modeless dialog; you may access other program functions while it is active. Click [Initialize] to verify that initial conditions meet the criteria for simulation. A summary of initial conditions is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 21-15), and the [Run] button is enabled. Click [Run] to perform the simulation. If the display of the network convergence monitor has been enabled, it is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 21-15). Otherwise, only the file path of the Channel Output file is displayed. After the simulation has been run to the specified time, disturbances and faults can be applied and the simulation run again to a new specified time (see Section 21.7, Applying Disturbances).
21-16
21-17
Additional Information
PSSE Program Operation Manual, Section 14.22, Initializing Models for Extended Term Simulation Section 14.23, Performing Extended Term Simulation in Time Steps
21-18
Faults applied in a dynamic simulation session are not preserved in Snapshot Files or Saved Case Files for use in the next session. The fault list is initialized to empty when PSSE is restarted and during the simulation initialization activities STRT, MSTR, ASTR, ESTR and GSTR. Unlike previous versions of PSSE, where it was necessary to use activities LOFL and RTRN to switch back and forth between the Dynamics and Power Flow modes, mode switching is now automatic. Therefore, disturbance functions can be accessed and run at any time.
A fault at a specified in-service bus (that is, Bus Type 1 or 2) can be applied using the [Apply a Bus Fault] dialog (Figure 21-18). Click [Select] to open [Bus Selection] where the desired bus with base kV may be selected. The Base kV field must contain a positive value in order to calculate Admittance using MHOs or OHMs. Default Admittance simulates a three phase fault. Specification of these data items is identical to the APPLY FAULT BUS command of activity PSAS.
21-19
Click [OK] to replace the fixed shunt at the designated bus with the MVA admittance equivalent for the negative and/or zero sequence networks to the Admittance values entered. The following summary is routed to the Progress tab.
*** BUS <number> [<bus name> <kV> ] SHUNT <number> = (<R value> , <X value> ) ADDED ***
A fault at the from bus end of a specified branch can be applied using the [Apply a Line Fault] dialog (Figure 21-19). If the branch to be faulted is a non-transformer branch or a two-winding transformer, it must be in-service. If the branch to be faulted is a three-winding transformer, the winding connected to the first bus specified must be in-service. Click [Select] to display [Branch Selection] where the desired buses and Circuit ID may be selected. The Base kV field of the from bus must contain a positive value in order to calculate Admittance using MHOs or OHMs. Default Admittance simulates a three phase fault. Specification of these data items is identical to the APPLY FAULT BRANCH command of activity PSAS.
21-20
Click [OK] to replace the line shunt at the from bus end of the designated branch with the MVA admittance equivalent for the negative sequence network and/or the zero sequence network to the Admittance values entered. The following summary is routed to the Progress tab. *** CKT <number> BUS <number> [<bus name> <kV> ] TO <number> [<bus name> <kV>] LINE SHUNT SET TO (<R value> , <X value>) ***
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
Any faults applied using [Apply a Bus Fault], [Apply a Line Fault], [Calculate and Apply a Bus Fault] and [Calculate and Apply Branch Unbalance] can be cleared using the [Clear Fault] dialog (Figure 21-20). The dialog lists those buses and/or branches that have been faulted in the current session. Highlight the fault to be cleared and click [Go]. The cleared bus or branch returns to its status previous to the application of a fault. A summary is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 21-21). You will need to click [Close] to end this activity.
21-21
The status of a line can be set to out-of-service using the [Trip a LIne] dialog (Figure 21-22). Click [Select] to display [Branch Selection] where the desired buses and Circuit ID may be selected.
Figure 21-22. Trip a Line Dialog Click [OK] to set the status of the designated branch to zero (out-of-service). A summary is routed to the Progress tab. *** CKT <number> BUS <number> [<bus name> <kV>] TO <number> [<bus name> <kV>] SET TO OUT-OF-SERVICE ***
21-22
The status of a line can be set to in-service using the [Close a Tripped Line] dialog (Figure 21-23). Only Type 1 or Type 2 bus branches can be faulted using this method. Click [Select] to display [Branch Selection] where the desired buses and Circuit ID may be selected. Click [OK] to set the status of the designated branch to one (in-service). A summary is routed to the Progress tab.
An in-service bus (i.e., a bus with a type code of one or two) can be electrically disconnected using the [Disconnect a Bus] dialog (Figure 21-24). Click [Select] to display [Bus Selection] where the desired bus may be specified. Click [OK] to electrically disconnect the specified bus. A summary is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 21-25).
21-23
An in-service machine (i.e., a machine with a service status of one connected to a Type 2 bus) can be electrically disconnected using the the [Disconnect a Machine] dialog (Figure 21-26). Click [Select] to display [Machine Selection] where the desired from bus and Machine ID may be specified.
21-24
Click [OK] to electrically disconnect the specified machine. The following summary is routed to the Progress tab.
*** MACHINE <number> AT BUS <number> [<bus name> <kV>] SET TO OUT-OF-SERVICE ***
The voltage reference (Vref) for any specified machine can be changed using the [AVR Reference (VREF)] dialog. Click [Select] to display [Machine Selection] where the desired from bus and Machine ID may be specified. The user must specify the Change Vref method: Increment/Decrement: change the existing Vref value in 0.010 steps. OR New value: change the existing Vref using a specified value
A positive value will increment the existing Vref, a negative value will decrement the existing Vref.
Click [OK] to reset the specified machines Vref value as indicated. The following summary is routed to the Progress tab. VREF AT BUS <number> [<bus name> <kV>] MACHINE "<ID>" CHANGED FROM <original value> TO <original value specified value>
21-25
The governor reference (Gref) for any specified machine can be changed using the [Governor Reference (GREF)] dialog. Click [Select] to display [Machine Selection] where the desired from bus and Machine ID may be specified. The user must specify the Change Gref method: Increment/Decrement: change the existing Gref value in 0.010 steps. OR New value: change the existing Gref using a specified value
A positive value will increment the existing Gref, a negative value will decrement the existing Gref.
Figure 21-28. Governor Reference (GREF) Change Dialog Click [OK] to reset the specified machines Gref value as indicated. The following summary is routed to the Progress tab. GREF AT BUS <number> [<bus name> <kV>] MACHINE "<ID>" CHANGED FROM <original value> TO <original value specified value>
21-26
The fault admittance for a specified bus can be calculated and applied during the dynamic simulations using the [Calculate and Apply a Bus Fault] dialog (Figure 21-29). The fault calculation is similar to that of activity SCMU except that a flat voltage profile of 1.0 is established as the default value. Sequence data must be present in the working case. Click [Select] to display [Bus Selection] where the desired bus may be specified. The user must specify the unbalance type, which activates the appropriate impedance fields for specification. The DC line and FACTS devices option is enabled only when this equipment is present in the working case. The user can block load unblocked DC lines and in-service FACTS devices or convert constant admittance load. A checkbox is available to enable Apply transformer impedance to zero correction only when the actual positive sequence impedance of a transformer in the working case differs from its nominal value. Otherwise, these transformers remain at their nominal values.
21-27
Click [OK] to initiate the fault calculation. The calculated equivalent positive sequence fault admittance of the driving point admittance for the negative sequence network and/or the zero sequence network is added to the fixed shunt at the designated bus. A summary is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 21-30).
Figure 21-30. Example of Dynamic Bus Fault Output This activity calculates the equivalent admittance for the negative and/or zero sequence networks of an unbalanced condition using activity SCMU (see PSSE Program Operation Manual, Section 9.7, Performing Fault Analysis under Unbalance Condition). The requirements and restrictions applicable to activity SCMU must be recognized. Further, the use of the dynamic fault calculation is restricted to the application of a single unbalance. It would not be valid to apply a fault using any of the methods described in this section, and then, with that fault is still applied, calculate the positive sequence equivalent of another unbalanced condition.
A positive sequence pi-equivalent for a single transmission line unbalance can be calculated and applied during the dynamic simulations using the [Calculate and Apply Branch Unbalance] dialog (Figure 21-31). The fault calculation is similar to that of activity SPCB except that a flat voltage profile of 1.0 is established as the default value. Sequence data must be present in the working case. Click [Select] to display [Branch Selection] where the desired buses and Circuit ID may be selected. The user must specify the Unbalance type and Type of in-line fault, which activate the appropriate impedance fields and fault location for specification. The availability of additional options is dependent upon the fault configuration.
21-28
The DC line and FACTS devices option is enabled only when this equipment is present in the working case. The user can block load unblocked DC lines and in-service FACTS devices or convert constant admittance load. A checkbox is available to enable Apply transformer impedance to zero correction only when the actual positive sequence impedance of a transformer in the working case differs from its nominal value. Otherwise, these transformers remain at their nominal values. Click [OK] to initiate the fault calculation. The calculated positive sequence pi-equivalent replaces the branch parameters of the branch subjected to the unbalance. A summary is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 21-32).
21-29
Figure 21-32. Example of Dynamic Line Fault Output This activity calculates the positive sequence equivalent of an unbalanced condition using activity SPCB (see PSSE Program Operation Manual, Section 9.14, Calculating pi-Equivalent, Single Transmission Line Unbalance). The requirements and restrictions applicable to activity SPCB must be recognized. Further, the use of the dynamic fault calculation is restricted to the application of a single unbalance. It would not be valid to apply a fault using any of the methods described in this section, and then, with that fault is still applied, calculate the positive sequence equivalent of another unbalanced condition.
21-30
This action allows the user to perform an Eigenvalue analysis using the optional NEVA module. The current dynamics simulation setup is transferred into NEVA, and the Eigenvalue analysis can be performed. A summary of the Python script process is routed to the Progress tab. For details on the use of NEVA, refer to the NEVA documentation.
21-31
Dynamic Simulation Solutions Building a State Variable Matrix for Linear Dynamic Analysis (LSYSAN)
21.9 Building a State Variable Matrix for Linear Dynamic Analysis (LSYSAN)
Activity ASTR
Requirements / Prerequisites Validly specified power flow case, solved to an acceptable mismatch level. Dynamics data exists in dynamics working memory.
The input file containing the A, B, H and F system matrices used in the LSYSAN program is specified using the [Build Matrices for LSYSAN] dialog (Figure 21-33). Click [ ] to open the selection window for the required Matrix Output file (*.lsa), which can be a new file or a previously-built file to be over-written. Use the [Add] and [Remove] buttons to specify desired States and Channels by range. If none are specified, the matrices are built using all States and the first 50 Channels. Click [Select] to display [Machine Selection] where the desired from bus and Machine ID may be specified. Leaving the Identifier field blank results in a PSSE-generated identifier. Input quantities may be specified as EFD, Pmech, Vothsg, Vref, or Var. The Perturbation and Var fields are editable. A checkbox enables the display of the network convergence monitor. Click [OK] to process the selected items and create the Matrix Output file for use in the LSYSAN program. A summary is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 21-34).
21-32
Dynamic Simulation Solutions Building a State Variable Matrix for Linear Dynamic Analysis (LSYSAN)
21-33
Dynamic Simulation Solutions Building a State Variable Matrix for Linear Dynamic Analysis (LSYSAN)
Section 14.15, Building a State Variable Matrix for Linear Dynamic Analysis (LSYSAN)
21-34
Chapter 22
Dynamic Simulation PlotPackage
22.1 PlotPackage Overview
The results of Dynamic Simulations are the plot channels of various PSSE quantities that are selected prior to performing the Dynamic Simulation. The plot channels captured during a Dynamic Simulation are contained in a plot channel output file which is in a binary form. These can be viewed either using the auxiliary program PSSPLT or the PlotPackage that was introduced in PSSE-31. The PSSE PlotPackage (or PlotPackage for brevity), unlike PSSPLT, is not an auxiliary program. Using PlotPackage, the channels captured during the dynamic simulation can be viewed and plotted directly from within PSSE. The initial version of PlotPackage that was released with PSSE-31 had support for some of the PSSPLT features. In future releases the full functionality of PSSPLT will be incorporated into PlotPackage. Until then both PSSPLT as well as PlotPackage will be shipped with PSSE. This chapter describes the various steps in viewing the dynamic simulation results using PlotPackage and provides a description of the various PlotPackage Operations (for a description of the PSSPLT, refer to the PSSPLT Program Manual).
22-1
22.2.1 PlotBook
The PlotBook signifies a book of plots. The PlotBook (similar to a note book) can contain several pages. Each page (also called a PlotPage) can contain several plots. Each plot can contain one or more curves or trace. The PlotBook is configured like an Excel Worksheet, with multiple pages, each capable of containing multiple Plots (see Figure 22-1, which shows a PlotBook with two PlotPages; Page 1 contains two plots).
Figure 22-1. PlotBook with Two PlotPages When a new PlotBook is opened, one page (Page 1) with one plot, as shown in Figure 22-2, is created by default.
22-2
Figure 22-2. Default PlotBook Layout Additional pages can be inserted using the command Edit > Insert Page. Additional plots can be inserted using the command Edit > Insert Plots. By default each page can have up to four plots per row. The active plot (in the selected page) is designated by a red border (see Figures 22-1 and 22-2). The configuration of the PlotBook (i.e., the number of pages, number of plots in each page, the number of plots in each row, etc.), is determined by the user. A plot configuration file can be created to pre-configure a PlotBook whenever one is opened. For details of various customization operations, refer to Section 22.3, PlotPackage Operations. A PlotBook is opened by clicking on File > New and selecting the Plot Book radio button as shown in Figure 22-3.
22-3
Figure 22-3. New PlotBook Dialog After a PlotBook is created, the next step is to open a channel output file.
22-4
(b) (a)
Figure 22-4. Opening a Channel Output File An alternative method, which combines the creation of PlotBook and the opening of a channel output file is to do the following: select File > Open, in the file selector dialog under the File type select the Channel Output file (*.out), and then select the channel output file as shown in Figure 224b. In order to open multiple channel output files, File > Open or File > Open Channel File Binary has to be repeated for each file. The names of all the open channel output file(s) appear in [Tree], which, when expanded, displays all the channel outputs that were selected prior to the Dynamic Simulation run.
22-5
22-6
Figure 22-5. PlotPackage File Menu The various operations that can be performed using the File menu are described below.
Creating a PlotBook
The use of any of the PlotBook functions first requires the creation of the PlotBook. This is done by selecting File > New > PlotBook in the dialog. A new PlotBook with one Plot Page and one Plot on the page is created. Details of creating a PlotBook are described in Creating a PlotBook.
22-7
Exporting a Plot
The active Plot may be exported to several different file formats by selecting File > Export and then selecting the desired format from the popup menu. A standard file save window appears, prompting for the name and location of the exported Plot. Currently, four file formats are available for export, Windows Metafile, Bitmap, JPEG, and PDF. Future releases will add other graphic formats.
Printing a Plot
PlotBooks may be printed in several ways. Selecting File > Print All Plots prints every Plot on every Plot Page in the PlotBook. Selecting File > Print Active Plot Page prints every Plot on the active Plot Page. Selecting File > Print Active Plot prints the active Plot on the Plot Page.
Plot Templates
Plot Attribute Dialogs can be used to modify the look and feel attributes of the PlotBook. The attributes available in these dialogs can be saved for later reuse via the Save Template Functionality. A template file is a binary file with the .plt extension that is used for storing plot look and feel attributes. Further details of Template Open and Save functionalities are given below.
More attributes will be added to the template file format in future releases. Active Page Template The Active Page template saves attributes for the active page including all the plots on the page. When restoring, this type of template is applied to the current page. Several active page templates can be combined to create a PlotBook template.
22-8
The Active Plot Template saves attributes for the currently selected plot (highlighted by a red dashed line). Several active plot templates can be combined to create an Active Page Template.
Figure 22-6. PlotPackage Edit Menu The Edit entry on the menu bar is used to define the PlotBook Setup and to access all the plotting specific functions of PSSE. Plotting functions can be accessed and run whenever the PlotBook is the active view. The various operations that be performed using the Edit menu are explained below.
22-9
Creating a Plot
A new Plot is created on the active Plot Page by selecting Edit > Insert Plot. The new Plot automatically becomes the active Plot.
Deleting Plots
Plots may be deleted from the PlotBook in several ways. Selecting Edit > Delete - All Plots deletes every Plot on every Plot Page in the PlotBook. Selecting Edit > Delete - Active Plot Page deletes every Plot on the active Plot Page. Selecting Edit > Delete - Active Plot deletes the active Plot on the Plot Page.
22-10
Figure 22-8. Plot Title Dialog The various options that are available in this dialog are explained in Table 22-1. Table 22-1. Description of Options in Plot Title Dialog
Option Text Visible Alignment Font Custom Position Description The title contents can be modified in the Text box. The plot is updated when the user clicks [Ok]. The Visible checkbox can be used to turn the title on or off. Checking the box displays the title. The title can be aligned at the top center, left, or right of the plot area. Click [Font] to display a Font Editor (Figure 22-9). The Font type, style, color and size can be modified here. The Custom Position checkbox is used to modify the location of the title.
22-11
22-12
Figure 22-10. Plot Legend Dialog The various options that are available in this dialog are explained in Table 22-2. Table 22-2. Description of Options in Plot Legend Dialog
Option Visible Font Series Color Font Description The Visible checkbox can be used to turn the legend on or off. Checking the box displays the legend. When the Font Series Color checkbox is selected, the legend displays the channel name with the same color as the channel on the plot. Click [Font] to invoke the Font Editor described above. Font characteristics for the legend text can be modified here.
22-13
22-14
Figure 22-11. Plot Series Dialog The options available in this dialog are shown in Table 22-3. Table 22-3. Description of Options in Plot Series Dialog
Option Series Name Color Point Visible Point Style Description The Series Name dropdown list displays all the channels present on the plot. All the attributes displayed refer to the channel selected in this list. Click [Color] to display a Color Selector. This is used to draw the channel on the plot. The Visible checkbox is used to turn the display of data points on/off. Each channel data point is represented by a symbol chosen from the Point Style list. The Style dropdown list allows the user to customize the type of symbol used to display data points when the Visible checkbox is selected.
22-15
22-16
Figure 22-12. Plot Axes Dialog Table 22-4 displays the options available in the Plot Axis Dialog. Table 22-4. Description of Options in Plot Axis Dialog
Option Axis Description The listbox contains a list of the 3 basic axes (bottom, left, right) as well as any custom axes that might be added to the plot. Information displayed in the dialog pertains to the axis selected in this list. To change the selection, click on the desired axis.
22-17
22-18
Figure 22-13. Plot Background Dialog Table 22-5 displays the options available in the Plot Background Dialog. Table 22-5. Description of Options in Plot Background Dialog
Option Color Browse (Back Image) Inside Transparent Stretch Tile Center Description Click [Color] to display a color selector, used to modify the background color of the plot. Click [Browse] to display a file selector that is used to place an image file on the plot. Any commonly used image format is acceptable. The Inside checkbox, when selected, causes the image to be placed inside the area enclosed by the plot axes. The Transparent checkbox, when selected, causes the image on the plot to appear transparent if the image supports transparency. The Stretch radio button, when checked, causes the image to be stretched so as to fit the entire display area for the plot. The Tile radio button, when checked, causes the image to be tiled across the plot display area. The Center button, when selected, centers the image within the plot display area.
22-19
Figure 22-14. Plot Annotation Dialog Table 22-6 displays the options available in the Plot Annotation Dialog.
22-20
Multiple Y Axes
The Multiple Y Axes menu item found under the Edit menu (Figure 22-15) enables and disables the addition of multiple vertical axes. The default setting is to disable the property. When checked, each new channel added to the plot is associated with a new vertical axis.
22-21
CrossHair Cursor
The crosshair cursor menu item under the Edit menu (Figure 22-15) enables and disables the cross hair cursor. When the cursor is enabled and the user clicks on a data point within the channel, its X, Y value is displayed. The default setting is crosshair cursor disabled.
22-22
Figure 22-17. Accessing Plot Editor via Context Menu The [Editing] dialog allows the configuration of various properties of the Plot, such as axis, titles, legend, colors, etc. (see Figure 22-18).
22-23
Figure 22-18. Plot Editor There are several controls in the Plot Editor, not all of which may be of use in for PSSE plots. Only those Plot Editor controls that are deemed to be of interest to PSSE users are described below. In a future PSSE release, the Plot Editor Controls will be simplified to provide access to only the required controls, thus making the editor more intuitive with fewer mouse clicks.
22-24
22-25
Figure 22-20. Change Scales of Axis It is possible to have several Y-axes. These are called Left Axis, Right Axis, etc. The X-axis is called the Bottom Axis. Selecting [Grid] from the Ticks subtab, Axis tab on the Chart [Editing] dialog (see Figure 22-21) permits removal of the grids on the selected axes (Left Axis, Bottom Axis, etc.).
22-26
Series Controls
Selecting [Color] from the Format tab on the Series [Editing] dialog supports changing the plot color.
22-27
Data Control
The X and Y values for every curve/trace in the selected Plot can be displayed by selecting the Data tab in the Plot Editor. This is a useful feature for the visual inspection of the X and the corresponding Y values.
22-28
Figure 22-25. Export Picture using Plot Editor Export Currently, four file formats are available for export, Windows Metafile, Bitmap, JPEG, and PDF. Future release will add other graphic formats.
22-29
Figure 22-26. Export Data to Excel File In order to Export it to, for example, an Excel file, select the series, click [Save], and specify the filename.
22-30
Chapter 23
Program Automation
23.1 Reproducing User Actions
A sequence of PSSE actions for batch commands may be recorded in a Python script (*.py, *.pyc, or *.pyw) or Response file (*.idv). See Section 23.2 for details on specific types of files.
A file selector window opens for specification of the type of file to record and the file name.
When done recording, select I/O Control > Stop recording to close the file.
23-1
An experienced user can create a response file using a text editor. The simplest and most robust way, however, is to select the I/O Control > Start recording option. Note that this is equivalent to executing activity ECHO in previous versions of PSSE. Having selected a file, the user executes the required sequence of activities or operations using the menu and toolbar functions in the interface. The resulting response file will contain, in Response File form, a series of commands reflecting the users sequence of activities. The user can to tailor this basic Response File for subsequent runs by editing the created response file by changing some of the filenames and bus numbers specifying faulted nodes, switched branches, and so on. As an example it can be assumed that, using the savnw.sav power flow case, the user wishes to open one circuit between buses 151 and 152, solve the case, and then display the power flow results for bus 151. Using the interface: Right-click the branch in [Diagram] and select Switch from the pop-up menu. Employ the Power Flow > Solution > Solve option or the Solve toolbar button. Select the Bus Based Output toolbar button and, subsequently, bus number 151.
If this series of operations were recorded, a response file would be constructed (see Figure 23-1).
Figure 23-1. Created Response File It can be seen that the Response file contains PSSE batch (BAT_) commands. Consequently, the manual creation of a Response File, which could be done with the text editor, requires an intimate familiarity with the PSSE batch commands. These commands are described in the PSSE API Manual.
23-2
23-3
Existing Python scripts (*.py), Response files (*.idv), IPLAN programs (*.irf) and PSAS/PSEB (*.psa/*.pse) command files may be executed from within the user interface. PSSE will open a file selector window and prompt for the appropriate filename to execute. Figure 23-2 shows the dialog for selecting an Automation File:
Figure 23-2. Select Program Automation File Dialog Only five file types are shown. This is because command line input and batch commands can be assembled in the same file, so the Response File file type (*.idv) is used for either (or both). When
23-4
the selected file is opened, the processes packaged in the Response file or programmed into the IPLAN or Python file will be initiated. A [Terminal Read] dialog (Figure 23-3) allows specification of data output to a file. Clicking [OK] without specifying a filename sends the data to a Report tab.
Select the desired IPLAN File (*.irf) from [Select Program Automation File to Run]. For details on the IPLAN programming language, the IPLAN language interface to the PSSE working case and dynamics data, and the IPLAN compiler, refer to the IPLAN Program Manual.
Additional Information
PSSE Program Operation Manual, Section 15.16, Launching an IPLAN Program File
23-5
Select the desired PSEB Command File (*.pse) from [Select Program Automation File to Run].
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
Select the desired PSAS Command File (*.psa) from [Select Program Automation File to Run].
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
23-6
Section 15.7.1, Arguments in Python Files Section 15.7.2, Arguments in Response Files Section 15.7.3, Arguments in IPLAN Files
When the re-run option is selected, the last-run automation file will run again without reselecting it from a file selector window. The [Terminal Read] dialog (Figure 23-3) allows specification of data output to a file. Clicking [OK] without specifying a filename sends the data to a Report tab.
23-7
If a text editor has been defined in the [Preferences] dialog (see Changing Program Preferences), selecting this option will display the last Automation file recorded by the program. If this is selected, the text editor will display the file as it is created. You may have to refresh the view in the text editor to see the changes in the file.
If a text editor has been defined in the [Preferences] dialog, selecting this option will display the last Automation file run by the program. If this is selected, the text editor will display the last Automation file run by the program. Selecting this item will re-run the last selected program automation file without forcing you to re-select it.
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
23-8
During the operation of PSSE, a variety of information is sent to the Progress tab. This function provides a mechanism for inserting descriptive comments. Comments can be directed to any output device selected for recording the work session (see OPEN). A comment or message is entered directly into the input field in the dialog.
23-9
23-10
Chapter 24
Output Controls
24.1 Directing Solution Output
Output from an interactive session in PSSE is typically directed to [Output] view. Since lists and reports can be lengthy, the user may direct the output to alternative devices.
24-1
By default, reports are sent to the Report tab in [Output] view. Options are available for redirecting reports to a file, printer, or to the current progress device. The option also exists for suppressing all reporting output. Report and progress destinations can be the same.
Figure 24-1. Report Output Destination Selector If the Printer option is selected, the user further specifies the printer and printing options. If file output is selected, the user must enter a filename in the Report output destination file field. Fortran forms control can be enabled if either file or printer output is specified. The Append to file, if file exists option may be selected if file output is selected. If enabled, then any new report output will be appended to the specified file instead of overwriting it.
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
24-2
This option can be used to direct Progress output to an alternative device. Specification for the [Progress Output Destination Selector] dialog is essentially the same as that described for directing Report output. The only difference is that the default output destination is the Progress tab.
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
Section 17.6, Selecting Progress Output Destination PSSE Program Operation Manual, Section 4.4, Virtual Output Devices
PSSE generated alerts and prompts are sent to Alerts/Warnings tab in [Output] view. The I/O Control > Direct Alert output and I/O Control > Direct Prompt output options direct these outputs to an alternate destination or suppress output. The dialogs are similar to those used for redirecting Progress and Report output.
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
Section 17.4, Selecting Prompt Output Destination PSSE Program Operation Manual, Section 4.4, Virtual Output Devices
24-3
Output Controls Setting the Path for Use with & Filenames
This function allows you to specify a directory path name that can later be represented by an ampersand (e.g., &myfile). This shorthand method for specifying a path name can be used by PSSE file accessing activities. A filename prefixed by this ampersand will be obtained from the directory specified in the path setting. Select the directory path to be accessed by the & short-hand method by clicking any file in the desired directory (see Figure 24-2).
Section 17.9, Setting the Path for Use with & Filenames PSSE Program Operation Manual, Section 2.4, PSSE Data Files
24-4
Chapter 25
Event Studies
25.1 Creating an Event Study
Highlight the Event Studies folder in [Dynamics Tree] and right-click to select Add Event Study. This action opens the selection window for the required Event Study file (*.evs). After entering a filename, click [Open] to open the [Event Study Properties] dialog (Figure 25-1). For dynamics event studies, modify the study Parameters from the default settings, as desired, select a channel file for the event study, if desired, and click [OK]. The event study is listed in the Event Studies folder in [Dynamics Tree], and the event study activity buttons become activated in the toolbar. Double-clicking the title in [Dynamics Tree] or right-clicking and selecting Edit re-opens [Event Study Properties] for modification.
25-1
Event Studies
25-2
[Dynamics Tree] > highlight Event Study > right-click > Add Event Item The [Event Item Properties] dialog (Figure 25-2) provides the means to configure an event study file with faults or disturbances. The following table displays the matrix of choices available. Network Item
Bus Load Machine Branch 3-Winding Transformer
Event Types
Unbalanced Bus Fault Bus Fault Disconnect Bus Connect Bus Disconnect Load Connect Load VREF Change Disconnect Machine Connect Machine GREF Change Unbalanced Line Fault Line Fault Line Trip Close Line Unbalanced Line Fault Line Fault Line Trip Close Line
A Clear Fault option is available to reset an event item. The Run Automation File option is not associated with any network item. It runs the specified automation file when the event item is executed. It is useful when doing pre/post processing in dynamic event studies.
25-3
Click [Select] to open the appropriate selection dialog to specify the event. Click [Add] to add the event item to the event study and open a new [Event Item Properties] dialog for the next item. [Dynamics Tree] displays an index of the event study as it is built (Figure 25-2). The event items are marked with an icon of the Event Type and the time. You may delete the event item using the right-click menu. [Network Tree] alters the network item icon with a red indicator, for example, . An [Event Study Spreadsheet] is also built as the event study is built. The Channel Identifier (event name) and Channel IPrint (time) cells may be edited, and the event item may be de-activated or re-activated from this spreadsheet. You will need to click [Close] to end this activity.
25-4
Figure 25-3. Example of Event Study Item List Event study items may be added to a Dynamics Event Study using the method described in Section 25.2.2, Short Circuit Event Studies. Event items may be copied or moved among event studies by using drag/drop in [Dynamics Tree]. To move an event item from one study to another, drag the event item to the destination study. To copy an event item, hold the [Ctrl] key while dragging the item.
Creating an Event Study Adding an event item from the [Network Tree] view requires higlighting the desired network element. A right-click displays a menu with an Add Event option, if you have created an Event Study file. Depending upon the network element and event type selected, one of the following dialogs is opened for your specification. [Network Tree] > Bus > right-click > Add Event > Create a bus fault event
25-5
[Network Tree] > Bus > right-click > Add Event > Create an unbalanced bus fault event
Figure 25-5. Create an Unbalanced Bus Fault Event Dialog [Network Tree] > Bus > right-click > Add Event > Create a connect bus event
Figure 25-6. Create a Connect Bus Event Dialog [Network Tree] > Bus > right-click > Add Event > Create a disconnect bus event
25-6
[Network Tree] > Branch > right-click > Add Event > Create a line fault event [Network Tree] > 2-WindingTransformer > right-click > Add Event > Create a line fault event [Network Tree] > 3-WindingTransformer > right-click > Add Event > Create a line fault event
Figure 25-8. Create a Line Fault Event Dialog [Network Tree] > Branch > right-click > Add Event > Create an unbalanced line fault event
25-7
[Network Tree] > Branch > right-click > Add Event > Create a line tripping event [Network Tree] > 2-WindingTransformer > right-click > Add Event > Create a line tripping event [Network Tree] > 3-WindingTransformer > right-click > Add Event > Create a line tripping event
Figure 25-10. Create a Line Tripping Event Dialog [Network Tree] > Branch > right-click > Add Event > Create a line closing event [Network Tree] > 2-WindingTransformer > right-click > Add Event > Create a line closing event [Network Tree] > 3-WindingTransformer > right-click > Add Event > Create a line closing event
25-8
[Network Tree] > highlightLoad > right-click > Add Event > Create a disconnect load event
Figure 25-12. Create a Disconnect Load Event Dialog [Network Tree] > highlight Load > right-click > Add Event > Create a connect load event
Figure 25-13. Create a Connect Load Event Dialog [Network Tree] > highlight Machine > right-click > Add Event > Create a Vref change event
25-9
[Network Tree] > highlight Machine > right-click > Add Event > Create a Gref change event
Figure 25-15. Create a Gref Change Event Dialog [Network Tree] > highlight Machine > right-click > Add Event > Create a disconnect machine event
Figure 25-16. Create a Disconnect Machine Event Dialog [Network Tree] > highlight Machine > right-click > Add Event > Create a connect machine event
Figure 25-17. Create a Connect Machine Event Dialog Click [OK] to add the event item to the event study. [Dynamics Tree] displays an index of the event study as it is built (Figure 25-2). The event items are marked with an icon of the Event Type and the time. You may delete the event item using the
25-10
right-click menu. [Network Tree] alters the network item icon with a red indicator, for example, . An [Event Study Spreadsheet] is also built as the event study is built. The Event Name and Time cells may be edited, and the event item may be de-activated or re-activated.
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
25-11
[Dynamics Tree] > highlight Event Study > right-click > Run Dynamic Event Study The Event Study must be active to run; the one last created or edited is considered active. If the study that you wish to run is not the active study, highlight the desired study, right-click, and select Make Active Study. The Event Study is run without further action on your part. A summary of conditions is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 25-18).
Additional Information
25-12
[Dynamics Tree] > highlight Event Study > right-click > Run Short Circuit Event Study The Event Study must be active to run; the one last created or edited is considered active. If the study that you wish to run is not the active study, highlight the desired study, right-click, and select Make Active Study. The Event Study is run without further action on your part. A summary of conditions is routed to the Progress tab (Figure 25-20). A full report is routed to the Report tab (Figure 25-20).
25-13
25-14
Chapter 26
Scenarios
PSSE studies are made up of a myriad number of files. Keeping track of these files has always been the responsibility of the PSSE user. A scenario file collects in one place all the files that are used in the study and can be used to automatically open files and perform automated operations upon open and close. A new facility allows the scenario editor to collect all the files contained in the scenario file into a zip archive file. This zip file, which contains all the files identified as being part of the study, can easily be exchanged and the whole study setup recreated on another users machine. When a scenario file is open, accessing files not currently in the scenario will automatically add them to the scenario.
The use of any of the Scenario functionality requires the creation of a Scenario file. The location of the Scenario file is important, typically the directory in which most of the files to be used in the study are located. Scenario files are created with, and identified by, a *.pssxml suffix.
When a scenario file is open, accessing files not currently in the scenario will automatically add them. You may also build your scenario interactively by using the scenario editor. The [Scenario Editor] dialog (Figure 26-1) provides a template where files may be added or deleted for a scenario. A dialog to change the root path to the location of the scenario file is also available. Double-clicking a column heading will sort them alphabetically.
26-1
Figure 26-1. Scenario Editor Dialog Click [Add file] to open the file addition dialog (Figure 26-2).
26-2
The user must specify the file type in order to open the appropriate directory of available files. The following file types may be added to a scenario:
RAW SAV DYR SNP SLD OUT SEQ OPF SUB MON CON Power Flow Raw Data file Saved Case file Dynamics Model Raw Data file Dynamics Snapshot Data file Slider Binary file Channel Output file Sequence Data file Optimal Power Flow Data file Subsystem Description file Monitored Element Description file Contingency Description Data file DFX ACC SBS PYT IDV IRF PSE PSA Distribution Factor Data file Contingency Solution Output file Bus Subsystem file Python file Response file Compiled IPLAN Program file PSEB Command file PSAS Command file
AUTO_OPEN Python, Response, IPLAN, PSEB or PSAS file AUTO_CLOS Python, Response, IPLAN, PSEB or PSAS file EVS UCT Event Study file (*.evs) UCTE Data file (*.uct)
Clicking [ ] opens the selection window. Highlight the file and click [Open] to return to the scenario dialog, and click [OK] to add the file to the scenario. Certain file types, such as RAW, SAV, DYR and SNP can only have one instance in a Scenario file. If one already exists, adding a new one replaces the existing file. Other files types, such as SLD, can have multiple instances in the Scenario File. The checkbox in the [Load?] column must be selected to enable loading a file when the scenario is opened. After all desired files have been added and enabled for loading, click [Save Scenario]. If you want to use the edited scenario at this time, click [Load Scenario]. You will need to click [OK] to end this activity. All files in the scenario can be compressed into a zip archive for transfer to another machine by clicking [Zip Scenario] to open the file compression dialog.
26-3
Opening a scenario loads all enabled files in the selected Scenario file (*.pssxml) into the working case. If another case is active, you will be prompted to save it and any associated Snapshot files. Any file in the scenario identified as an AUTO_OPEN file will be executed when the scenario file is loaded if the [Load?] item is checked. This allows automatic execution of any Automation file that performs study pre-processing.
Closing the Scenario file will close/unload all files specified in the Scenario file. Any file in the scenario identified as an AUTO_CLOS file will be executed when the scenario file is closed if the [Load?] item is checked. This allows automatic execution of any Automation file that performs study post-processing.
Additional Information E Program Operation Manual, PSS
26-4
Appendix A
Summary of Toolbar Selections
File
New Case / Diagram New Case / Diagram Open Save Cut Copy Paste Delete Undo Print Preview
Open
Save
Cut
Copy
Paste
Delete
Undo
Print Preview
Create a new case or diagram. Open an existing file. Save the active documents. Cut the selection and put it on the clipboard. Copy the selection and put it on the clipboard. Insert clipboard contents. Delete selected items. Undo the previous action. Print preview.
Show or hide the network tree. Show or hide [Output]. Show or hide [Command Line]. Display program information, version number and copyright.
A-1
Diagram
Select
Rotate Symbols
Rotate +90
Rotate -90
Show Grid
Snap to Grid
Select
Select diagram items in [Diagram]. Items can be selected using common selection techniques (e.g., dragging a rectangle around several objects, clicking an item and then holding down the [Ctrl] key to add more selections to the selection list). The selected items can then be manipulated* in many ways. Rotate diagram items. If the rotation item is selected, and then a diagram item is selected, the cursor changes to a circular arrow. Holding down the left mouse button while dragging the cursor will rotate the selected item around its center. Rotate a selected item positive 90 degrees. Rotate a selected item negative 90 degrees. Toggle on or off the display of a grid in [Diagram]. Toggle on or off the feature that causes the location of any newly created diagram item to snap to the nearest grid point in [Diagram].
* Manipulation implies that an existing [Diagram] can be modified subsequent to its construction or during its development. Creation implies that diagram items, network items or simple annotation items, are selected from the Diagram Toolbar for construction of a new network diagram. This can imply the construction of a new power flow case if the diagram items are bound to network items.
Sizable Busbar
Horizontal Sizable Bus Node Branch Breaker Switch Load Generator Busbar
The basic building block of a PSSE case and [Diagram]. Buses need to exist in a [Diagram] before any lines or equipment can be drawn. Buses have a number of discrete ports arranged along both sides of the busbar. When connecting lines and equipment to a bus, the connection point will snap to the nearest port. The same as a regular bus, except that when drawn on the [Diagram] it is placed horizontally across the screen instead of vertically. Select when busbar representation of the bus is not desired. The bus node has a number of ports stacked in the center of the node. When connecting lines or equipment to a bus node, the connection point will snap to the center.
A-2
Branch*
Select to create a line between two buses. When the branch element is selected, the cursor changes to a crosshair. The branch is started by placing the cross-hair on the from bus and clicking. Any number of intermediate kneepoints may then be created by clicking the towards the to bus. Clicking the to bus will complete the creation of the branch. Select to create a line with a breaker between two buses. When the breaker element is selected, the cursor changes to a crosshair. The line is started by placing the cross-hair on the from bus and clicking. Clicking the to bus will complete the creation of the breaker element. Select to create a line with a switch between two buses. When the switch element is selected, the cursor changes to a crosshair. The line is started by placing the cross-hair on the from bus and clicking. Clicking the to bus will complete the creation of the switch element. Select to create a load on a bus. When the load element is selected, the cursor changes to a crosshair. The load is started by placing the crosshair on the bus and pressing the left mouse button. The mouse is then dragged to where the load symbol is to appear and released. Select to create a generator on a bus. When the generator element is selected, the cursor changes to a crosshair. The generator is started by placing the crosshair on the bus and pressing the left mouse button. The mouse is then dragged to where the generator symbol is to appear and released.
Breaker
Switch
Load
Generator
* At any point during the creation of a branch, breaker, or switch, the element may be canceled and removed by pressing the [Esc] key. The attachment point of an element on a bus may be changed by [Ctrl] clicking the attachment point of the element and then moving it to another port on the bus.
FACTS Device
2-Winding Transformer
3-Winding Transformer
2-Terminal dc Line
VSC dc Line
Switched Shunt
Select to create a switched shunt on a bus. When the switched shunt element is selected, the cursor changes to a crosshair. The switched shunt is started by placing the crosshair on the bus and pressing the left mouse button. The mouse is then dragged to where the switched shunt symbol is to appear and released. Select to create a fixed shunt on a bus. When the fixed shunt item is selected, the cursor changes to a crosshair. The fixed shunt is started by placing the crosshair on the bus and pressing the left mouse button. The mouse is then dragged to where the fixed shunt symbol is to appear and released.
Fixed Shunt
A-3
FACTS Device
Select to create a FACTS device between two buses. The FACTS device is started by selecting one or two buses. One bus is selected to create a shunt element FACTS device. Two buses are selected to create a series element FACTS device. When the FACTS device item is selected, the cursor changes to a crosshair. If a single bus was selected, the FACTS device is started by placing the crosshair on the selected bus and pressing the left mouse button. The mouse is then dragged to where the FACTS device is to appear and released. If two buses were selected, the FACTS device is started by placing the crosshair on the sending bus and clicking. Any number of intermediate kneepoints may then be created by clicking the way to the terminal bus. Clicking the terminal bus will complete the creation of the FACTS device. At any point during the creation of the FACTS device, the FACTS device may be canceled and removed by pressing the [Esc] key. Used to create a two-winding transformer between two buses. The two-winding transformer is started by placing the crosshair on the from bus and clicking. Any number of intermediate kneepoints may then be created by clicking the way to the to bus. Clicking the to bus will complete the creation of the two-winding transformer. Select to create a three-winding transformer between three buses. The threewinding transformer is created by first selecting three buses. The three buses will be regarded as the FROM, TO, and last bus in the order they were initially selected. The three-winding transformer item is then selected, the cursor placed in [Diagram] at the desired location for the symbol to be placed, and the left mouse button clicked. Any number of intermediate kneepoints may be added to the links between the symbol and the three buses, or the attachment points modified in the manner described above. Select to create a two-terminal dc line between two buses. When the dc line item is selected, the cursor changes to a crosshair. The dc line is started by placing the crosshair on the from bus and clicking. Any number of intermediate kneepoints may then be created by clicking towards the to bus. Clicking the to bus will complete creation of the dc line. Select to create a VSC dc line between two buses. When the VSC dc line item is selected, the cursor changes to a crosshair. The VSC dc line is started by placing the crosshair on the from bus and clicking. Any number of intermediate kneepoints may then be created by clicking towards the to bus. Clicking the to bus will complete creation of the VSC dc line. Select to open a dialog that displays a list of available diagram templates.
Two-winding Transformer*
Three-winding Transformer
Two-terminal dc Line
* At any point during the creation of the two-winding transformer, two-terminal dc line, or VSC dc line the twowinding transformer may be canceled and removed by pressing the [Esc] key. The attachment point of an element on a bus may be changed by [Ctrl] clicking the attachment point of the element and then moving it to another port on the bus.
A-4
Kneepoint
Annotation Text
Diagram Title
Diagram Legend
Summation Label
Kneepoint
Select to put bends, or kneepoints, in a link that connects two diagram items. Links are used to represent lines, the connections between two- and three-winding transformer symbols and buses, and the connections between equipment and buses. When the kneepoint item is selected the cursor changes to a crosshair. Clicking a link will place a red square on the link. This red square can later be dragged with the select item to achieve the desired shape. Kneepoints can be deleted by selecting the kneepoint and pressing the [Delete] key. Select to place annotation text anywhere on [Diagram]. The annotation text item is selected and text can then be placed anywhere in [Diagram] by clicking at the location to display the text annotation. Select to place a title on [Diagram]. The title item displays the two-line diagram title as well as the time and date of the last diagram update on the third line. The time and date is updated on the title item whenever a solution is run and the diagram is open in the application. The title item is selected and titles can then be placed anywhere in [Diagram] by clicking the location where the title is to be placed. Select to place a legend on [Diagram]. The legend item displays the two-line diagram legend. The legend item is selected and legends can then be placed anywhere in [Diagram] by clicking at the location where the legend is to be displayed. Select to place a Diagram File Block on [Diagram]. The Diagram File Block contains the current case filename and the current Diagram filename. The files item is selected and file blocks can then be placed anywhere in [Diagram] by clicking the location where the file block is to be displayed. Select to place a summation record on [Diagram]. The summation item is selected and summations can then be placed anywhere in [Diagram] by clicking. As each summation is placed, the Edit Summation dialog is displayed that allows the setting of the summation records (see Section 3.8.3, Adding a Summation Record). Select to place a report node record on [Diagram]. The report node item is selected and report nodes can then be placed anywhere in [Diagram] by clicking. As each report node is placed, the [Edit Report Node] dialog is displayed that allows the setting of the report nodes (see Section 3.8.4, Adding a Report Node).
Annotation Text
Diagram Title
Diagram Legend
Summation Label
A-5
Zoom
Zoom In
Zoom Out
Zoom Window
Zoom 100%
Zoom Window
Zoom Previous
Pan
Select a predefined magnification to apply to [Diagram]. Click the arrow to the right of the combo box for a pull-down list of predefined magnification from which to choose. You can also type in a desired magnification if it is not found in the list. The Zoom Combo Box is automatically reflects the current magnification, which can be changed through the use of the other zoom tools. Increase/decrease magnification of the diagram. Increase/decrease diagram magnification to fill window. Quickly return [Diagram] magnification to actual size. Increase/decrease magnification of a selected portion of [Diagram]. The user selects this item and then drags a rectangle over [Diagram] to encompass the part of [Diagram] to be zoomed. The selected part of the [Diagram] is then zoomed to fit in the extent of [Diagram] window. Quickly return the [Diagram] magnification to its previous setting. Scroll around the [Diagram]. Upon selecting this item, the cursor in [Diagram] changes to a hand. [Diagram] is then panned by holding down the left mouse button and dragging the hand around the window.
Zoom in/Zoom out Zoom Extent Zoom 100% Zoom Window Zoom Previous Pan
General Task
Auto Draw
Locate Bus
Program Settings
Select All Buses Create Bus Subsystem Toggle Bus Subsystems GOUT/GEXM Auto Draw Locate Bus Program Settings Create/Modify Config Files
Select all buses. Create a bus subsystem. Toggle between the primary bus subsystem and an alternate. Create a graphical power flow bus display (GOUT/GEXM). Set interaction mode to automatically draw parts of the network. Locate and center the selected bus on the Diagram. Change general program settings. Create or modify SUB, MON, and CON configuration files.
A-6
Automation
Stop Recording
Start recording automation file. Stop recording automation file. Select and run a program automation file. Run the last used program automation file. Edit the last automation file recorded. Edit the last program automation file used.
Re-run Automation File Edit Last Recorded Automation File Edit Last Run Automation File
Reporting
List Data
Bus-Based Reports
AC Reports
Graphical Report
Export to Excel
List Data Bus-Based Reports Area/Zone Based Reports Limit Checking Reports Area/Owner /Zone Totals AC Reports Append AC Output File Graphical Report Export to Excel
List Powerflow, sequence and OPF data. Generate Bus based reports. Generate Area/Zone based reports. Generate limit checking reports. Generate Area/Owner/Zone total reports. Generate ac contingency solution output reports. Append to existing ac contingency solution output file. Create a graphical report. Export report to an Excel spreadsheet.
A-7
Toggle Power Flow Impedance Case ASCC Fault Annotation Label Results Data Comparison Analysis Toggle Labels Annotation Power Flow Results Impedance Data Case Comparison ASCC Fault Analysis IEC Fault Analysis Reliability Dynamics
Reliability
Dynamics
Show or hide the display of labels on the active diagram. Edit the diagram annotation on the active diagram. Display power flow results on the active diagram. Display power flow impedance data on the active diagram. Run graphical case comparison on the active diagram. Display automatic sequencing fault analysis on the active diagram. Display IEC results on the active diagram. Display reliability results on the active diagram. Display dynamics results on the active diagram.
Animate Flows Animate Flows Current Loadings Multi-Section Line Reporting Lock Diagram
Current Loadings
Lock Diagram
Animate flows on the active diagram. Display current loading bar charts on the active diagram. Multisection Line reporting on the active diagram. Lock the diagram.
A-8
Analysis
Solution Settings Solution Settings Solve PV Analysis PV Analysis - Previous QV Analysis QV Analysis - Previous
Solve
PV Analysis
PV Analysis - Previous
QV Analysis
QV Analysis - Previous
Change network solution settings. Solve. Perform a PV analysis. Perform a PV analysis using previous results. Perform a QV analysis. Perform a QV analysis using previous results.
ACCC Multi-ACCC
Substation Network Inertial Solve for N-1-1 Reliability Connectivity Load Switching Analysis Assessment Check Flow
ACCC Multi-ACCC AC Corrective Actions Reliability Assessment Substation Reliability Assessment Network Connectivity Check Solve for Switching Inertial Load Flow N-1-1 Analysis
Perform ac contingency calculation. Perform multi-level ac contingency calculation. Perform ac corrective actions. Perform reliability assessment. Perform substation reliability assessment. Perform network connectivity check (TREE). Perform switching study (TYSL). Perform Newton-Raphson solution with inertial / governor dispatch (INLF). Perform N-1-1 analysis.
A-9
Topology
Scale
Split Bus
Join Buses
Tap Line
Scale Split Bus Join Buses Tap Line Move Network Elements Delete Network Elements Disconnect/Reconnect Bus
Scale load, generation, and shunts. Split a bus into two buses. Join two buses into one. Insert another bus into a line. Move equipment /lines between buses. Delete buses/equipment/lines. Disconnect/Reconnect bus to network.
Fault Analysis
Set Up Unbalanced Network Set Up Unbalanced Network Solve Unbalanced Network Unbalanced Report
Unbalanced Report
Setup network for unbalanced solution. Solve and report network with unbalances. Unbalanced network report. Automatic sequence fault calculation.
IEC 60909 Fault Calculation IEC 60909 LL Fault Calculation IEC 60909 LLG Fault Calculation IEC 60909 LG Fault Calculation IEC 60909 LLLG Fault Calculation
IEC 60909 fault calculation. Perform an IEC LL fault calculation. Perform an IEC LLG fault calculation. Perform an IEC LG fault calculation. Perform an IEC LLLG fault calculation.
A-10
OPF Solution Settings OPF Solution Settings Solve OPF OPF Spreadsheet OPF Data Tables
Solve OPF
OPF Spreadsheet
Change OPF solution settings. Solve OPF. Make the OPF spreadsheet active. Create/modify OPF data tables.
Activation
Network Spreadsheet
OPF Spreadsheet
Dynamics Spreadsheet
Model Spreadsheet
Slider Diagram
Event Spreadsheet
Network Spreadsheet OPF Spreadsheet Dynamics Spreadsheet Model Spreadsheet Dynamics Plot Sheet Slider Diagram Event Spreadsheet
Make the Network spreadsheet active. Make the OPF spreadsheet active. Make the Dynamics spreadsheet active. Make the Model spreadsheet active. Make the Dynamics plot sheet active. Make the Slider Diagram active. Make the Event spreadsheet active.
Contour
Enable Contours Enable Contours Contour Settings Refresh Contours Remove Contours
Contour Settings
Refresh Contours
Remove Contours
Enable color contouring. Edit contour settings. Refresh contours. Remove contours.
A-11
Dynamics Simulation
Model Maintenance
Dynamic Simulation
Exciter Simulation
Dynamic Simulation Options Dynamics Solution Parameters Model Maintenance Dynamic Simulation Exciter Simulation Exciter Response Simulation Governor Response Simulation Extended Term Simulation
Change Dynamic simulation options. Change Dynamics solution parameters. Perform network model maintenance functions. Initialize and perform a Dynamic simulation. Initialize and perform an Exciter simulation. Initialize and perform an Exciter response ratio simulation. Initialize and perform a Governor Response simulation. Initialize and perform an Extended Term simulation.
Channel Setup Wizard Subsystem Channel Selection Bus Channel Selection Line Channel Selection Load Channel Selection Machine Channel Selection VAR/STATE Channel Selection
Launch Channel Setup Wizard. Select channels by subsystem. Select bus channels. Select branch and 3 winding transformer channels. Select load channels. Select machine channels. Select VAR/STATE channels.
A-12
Bus Fault Bus Fault Line Fault Clear Fault Trip Line Close Line Bus Disconnect Machine Disconnect
Line Fault
Clear Fault
Trip Line
Close Line
Bus Disconnect
Machine Disconnect
Apply a bus fault. Apply a line fault. Clear a fault. Trip a line. Close a line. Disconnect a bus. Disconnect a machine.
Branch Unbalance
Change Vref
Change Gref
Unbalanced Bus Fault Branch Unbalance Change Vref Change Gref List Model Data List Dynamics Data List Model Storage Locations
Calculate and apply an unbalanced bus fault. Calculate and apply a branch unbalance. Change or increment Vref. Change or increment Gref. List model and data by model type. List Dynamics variables in network. List model storage locations by type and subsystem.
A-13
NEVA Eigenvalue Analysis NEVA Eigenvalue Analysis Force Generator Conversion Update Plot Book Update Dynamic Diagram
Force generator conversion when initializing Dynamic Simulation. Update Plot Book during Dynamic Simulation if Plot every <n> time steps option is specified. Update Dynamic Diagram during Dynamic Simulation if Plot every <n> time steps option is specified.
Scenarios
New Scenario New Scenario Open Scenario Save Scenario Close Scenario Edit Scenario
Open Scenario
Save Scenario
Close Scenario
Edit Scenario
Create new scenario. Open existing scenario. Save open scenario. Close open scenario. Edit existing scenario.
Event Studies
Run Dynamic Event Study Run Dynamic Event Study Run Short Circuit Event Study Add Event Item
Launch dynamic event study. Launch short circuit event study. Add event item to existing event study.
A-14
Diagram Primitives
Line Primitive
Arc Primitive
Circle Primitive
Ellipse Primitive
Rectangle Primitive
Region Primitive
Select to place annotation lines anywhere on [Diagram]. The line primitive item is selected and lines can then be placed anywhere in [Diagram] by clicking. Be aware, they are not branches! Select to place annotation arcs anywhere on [Diagram]. The arc primitive item is selected and arcs can then be placed anywhere in [Diagram] by clicking. Select to place annotation circles anywhere on [Diagram]. The circle primitive item is selected and circles can then be placed anywhere in the [Diagram] by clicking. Select to place annotation ellipses anywhere on [Diagram]. The ellipse primitive item is selected and ellipses can then be placed anywhere in [Diagram] by clicking. Select to place annotation rectangles anywhere on [Diagram]. The rectangle primitive item is selected and rectangles can then be placed anywhere in [Diagram] by clicking. Select to place annotation regions anywhere on [Diagram]. The region primitive item is selected and multi-segment polygon regions can then be placed anywhere in [Diagram] by clicking the end point for each edge of the polygon. The region is complete when the last point clicked is on the first point.
Ellipse Primitive
Rectangle Primitive
Region Primitive
Diagram Options
Toggle Auto-Position Toggle Auto-Position Toggle Bus Manage Diagram Layers Manage Diagram Views
Toggle Bus
Toggle auto-position for selected elements. Toggle bus symbol orientation. Manage order of [Diagram] layers. Manage [Diagram] saved views.
Custom Toolbar
Refer to Section 5.3, Creating Custom Toolbars to establish functions for a custom toolbar.
A-15
Redirect Output
Redirect Report Redirect Output Progress Output Redirect Report Output Redirect Progress Output Redirect Alert Output Redirect Prompt Output
Redirect reports to a file, printer, or to the current progress device; suppress all reporting output. Redirect progress to a file, printer, or to the current progress device; suppress all progress output. Redirect alerts to an alert box, file, printer, or to the current progress or reporting device; suppress all alerts output. Redirect prompts and warnings to a prompt window, file, printer, or to the current progress or reporting device; suppress all prompts output.
A-16
Status Bar
The Status bar fields, when in view, indicate various conditions for the users reference. Interactions with [Diagram] cause updates to items in the fields. The fields are listed below.
Select an object on which to get Help Pops up tooltip on diagram component under cursor. Met convergence tolerance Powerflow results MW/Mvar flow 4.08, -1.49 Notification that the last activity run met the specified limits. Indicates the type of results currently shown in [Diagram]. These include, power flow, impedances, case differences, and short circuit results. Indicates units currently in use for the indicated type of results. The current cursor location in [Diagram] is constantly updated in the Status bar. The X and Y location of the cursor are displayed in the units specified for [Diagram] in [Diagram Settings]. The current binding mode for new items created in [Diagram] is displayed in the Status bar. The field displays either Bind items, indicating that new network items added to [Diagram] will create new data in the working case, or No binding, indicating that no data is added to the working case. Items added when this field displays No binding will be displayed in the color red, indicating no corresponding case data exists. The next bus number for new buses created in [Diagram] is also displayed in the Status bar. Autonumbering is handled with the Power Flow Options menu; see Section 11.1, Specifying Solution Parameters. If autonumbering is on, this field displays the number of the next bus created. If autonumbering is off, this field displays Autonumber disabled.
Bind items
Next bus - 1
A-17
A-18
Appendix B
Network Component Data Records
Following are screen captures of the data records available when PSSE-32.0.0 was released. Since data records are a new feature, other network components may be updated using these dialogs, depending upon the version of PSSE you are using. See Section 3.6.1, Using Data Records for a description of their use.
B-1
B-2
B-4
B-6
B-7
B-8
B-9
B-10
B-11
B-12